1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
40 #include <sys/types.h>
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
54 #include "character.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
59 #include "termhooks.h"
62 #include "emacs-icon.h"
67 #include "intervals.h"
72 #include "xsettings.h"
74 #include "sysselect.h"
77 #include <X11/Shell.h>
85 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
90 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
94 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
96 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget
, XtPointer
, XEvent
*, Boolean
*);
97 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
99 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
101 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
102 #if defined USE_MOTIF
103 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
104 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
105 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
108 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
109 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
110 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
111 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
112 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
113 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
114 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
116 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
117 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
118 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
119 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
121 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
125 #ifndef XtNinitialState
126 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
130 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
133 #include <X11/XKBlib.h>
136 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
140 int use_xim
= 0; /* configure --without-xim */
143 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
146 static bool any_help_event_p
;
148 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
151 struct x_display_info
*x_display_list
;
153 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
154 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
155 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
156 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
158 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list
;
160 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
162 static struct frame
*pending_autoraise_frame
;
164 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
169 } pending_event_wait
;
172 /* The application context for Xt use. */
173 XtAppContext Xt_app_con
;
174 static String Xt_default_resources
[] = {0};
176 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
178 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
;
179 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
181 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
182 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
183 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
185 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
;
189 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
190 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
191 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
192 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
194 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
196 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
197 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
198 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
199 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
200 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
201 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
202 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
203 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
204 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
207 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
209 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph
;
210 static struct frame
*last_mouse_glyph_frame
;
212 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
214 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
215 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
218 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
219 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
222 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar
;
224 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
225 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
226 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
227 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
228 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
229 it's somewhat accurate. */
231 static Time last_mouse_movement_time
;
233 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
235 static Time last_user_time
;
237 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
240 static int volatile input_signal_count
;
242 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
244 static int x_noop_count
;
246 static Lisp_Object Qalt
, Qhyper
, Qmeta
, Qsuper
, Qmodifier_value
;
248 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms
;
249 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1
;
252 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
253 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file
;
255 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
256 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock
;
259 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
260 static char emacs_class
[] = EMACS_CLASS
;
264 XEMBED_MAPPED
= 1 << 0
269 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY
= 0,
270 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE
= 1,
271 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE
= 2,
272 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
= 3,
274 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT
= 5,
275 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT
= 6,
276 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV
= 7,
278 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON
= 10,
279 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF
= 11,
280 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR
= 12,
281 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR
= 13,
282 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR
= 14
285 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display
*, Colormap
, XColor
*);
286 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame
*, int, int, int);
287 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame
*);
288 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame
*);
289 static const XColor
*x_color_cells (Display
*, int *);
290 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display
*);
291 static struct terminal
*x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info
*);
292 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal
*);
293 static void x_update_end (struct frame
*);
294 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame
*);
295 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame
*);
296 static _Noreturn
void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame
*, int, int);
297 static void frame_highlight (struct frame
*);
298 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame
*);
299 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info
*, struct frame
*);
300 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info
*,
301 struct frame
*, struct input_event
*);
302 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info
*,
303 XEvent
*, struct input_event
*);
304 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame
*);
305 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info
*);
306 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*);
307 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*, int,
308 enum text_cursor_kinds
);
310 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*,
311 enum glyph_row_area
, GC
);
312 static void x_flush (struct frame
*f
);
313 static void x_update_begin (struct frame
*);
314 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window
*);
315 static struct scroll_bar
*x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display
*, Window
);
316 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**, Lisp_Object
*,
317 enum scroll_bar_part
*,
318 Lisp_Object
*, Lisp_Object
*,
320 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame
*, XPropertyEvent
*);
321 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame
*);
322 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame
*, int, int);
323 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame
*, int, int, int);
324 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info
*, XEvent
*,
325 int *, struct input_event
*);
327 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent
*, Display
*);
329 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
330 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
331 static void x_connection_closed (Display
*, const char *);
332 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame
*, int);
333 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame
*, ptrdiff_t);
334 static void x_initialize (void);
337 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
340 x_flush (struct frame
*f
)
342 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
343 connection may be broken. */
344 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay
))
350 eassert (FRAME_X_P (f
));
351 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
355 /* Flush all displays and so all frames on them. */
356 struct x_display_info
*xdi
;
357 for (xdi
= x_display_list
; xdi
; xdi
= xdi
->next
)
358 XFlush (xdi
->display
);
364 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
365 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
366 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
367 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
368 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
371 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
374 /***********************************************************************
376 ***********************************************************************/
380 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
381 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
389 struct record event_record
[100];
391 int event_record_index
;
394 record_event (char *locus
, int type
)
396 if (event_record_index
== sizeof (event_record
) / sizeof (struct record
))
397 event_record_index
= 0;
399 event_record
[event_record_index
].locus
= locus
;
400 event_record
[event_record_index
].type
= type
;
401 event_record_index
++;
408 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
410 struct x_display_info
*
411 x_display_info_for_display (Display
*dpy
)
413 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
415 for (dpyinfo
= x_display_list
; dpyinfo
; dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
)
416 if (dpyinfo
->display
== dpy
)
423 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame
*f
)
425 struct x_output
*x
= f
->output_data
.x
;
426 Window win
= None
, wi
= x
->parent_desc
;
427 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
429 while (wi
!= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
)
433 unsigned int nchildren
;
436 XQueryTree (dpy
, win
, &root
, &wi
, &children
, &nchildren
);
443 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
446 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame
*f
)
448 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
449 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
450 Window win
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
452 double alpha_min
= 1.0;
456 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
461 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
))
462 alpha_min
= XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
);
463 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
))
464 alpha_min
= (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
)) / 100.0;
468 else if (alpha
> 1.0)
470 else if (0.0 <= alpha
&& alpha
< alpha_min
&& alpha_min
<= 1.0)
473 opac
= alpha
* OPAQUE
;
475 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
477 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
478 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
479 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
480 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
482 parent
= x_find_topmost_parent (f
);
484 XChangeProperty (dpy
, parent
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
485 XA_CARDINAL
, 32, PropModeReplace
,
486 (unsigned char *) &opac
, 1L);
488 /* return unless necessary */
493 unsigned long n
, left
;
495 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, win
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
496 0L, 1L, False
, XA_CARDINAL
,
497 &actual
, &format
, &n
, &left
,
500 if (rc
== Success
&& actual
!= None
)
502 unsigned long value
= *(unsigned long *)data
;
512 XChangeProperty (dpy
, win
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
513 XA_CARDINAL
, 32, PropModeReplace
,
514 (unsigned char *) &opac
, 1L);
519 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
521 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
525 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
527 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
531 /***********************************************************************
532 Starting and ending an update
533 ***********************************************************************/
535 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
536 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
537 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
538 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
539 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
542 x_update_begin (struct frame
*f
)
548 /* Start update of window W. */
551 x_update_window_begin (struct window
*w
)
553 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
554 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
);
556 w
->output_cursor
= w
->cursor
;
560 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
562 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
563 hlinfo
->mouse_face_defer
= 1;
565 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
567 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f
))
568 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
575 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
578 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window
*w
, int x
, int y0
, int y1
)
580 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
583 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID
);
585 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
588 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
589 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, x
, y0
, x
, y1
);
592 /* End update of window W.
594 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
595 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
597 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
598 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
599 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
601 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
602 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
606 x_update_window_end (struct window
*w
, bool cursor_on_p
,
607 bool mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
609 if (!w
->pseudo_window_p
)
614 display_and_set_cursor (w
, 1,
615 w
->output_cursor
.hpos
, w
->output_cursor
.vpos
,
616 w
->output_cursor
.x
, w
->output_cursor
.y
);
618 if (draw_window_fringes (w
, 1))
619 x_draw_vertical_border (w
);
624 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
625 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
626 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
627 reset_mouse_highlight (MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w
->frame
)));
631 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
635 x_update_end (struct frame
*f
)
637 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
638 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
)->mouse_face_defer
= 0;
642 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
648 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c
649 whenever a complete update has been performed. */
652 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame
*f
)
655 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f
);
659 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
660 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
661 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. This function is called from
662 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
663 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
666 x_after_update_window_line (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*desired_row
)
673 if (!desired_row
->mode_line_p
&& !w
->pseudo_window_p
)
674 desired_row
->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p
= 1;
676 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
677 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
678 check here if updated window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
679 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
680 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
681 overhead is very small. */
682 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
683 && desired_row
->full_width_p
684 && (f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
),
685 width
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
687 && (height
= desired_row
->visible_height
,
690 int y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, desired_row
->y
));
693 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
694 0, y
, width
, height
);
695 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
696 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - width
,
703 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params
*p
)
705 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
706 Display
*display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
707 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
708 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
709 struct face
*face
= p
->face
;
711 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
712 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, ANY_AREA
, gc
);
716 int bx
= p
->bx
, by
= p
->by
, nx
= p
->nx
, ny
= p
->ny
;
718 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
719 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
720 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
721 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
723 XSetFillStyle (display
, face
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
725 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->background
);
727 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
728 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
729 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
730 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
731 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
)
732 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
733 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
)
734 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
)))
736 int sb_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
);
740 int bar_area_x
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
741 int bar_area_width
= (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
)
742 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
));
746 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
747 if (bar_area_x
+ bar_area_width
== p
->x
)
748 bx
= bar_area_x
+ sb_width
;
749 else if (p
->x
+ p
->wd
== bar_area_x
)
753 int header_line_height
= WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w
);
755 nx
= bar_area_width
- sb_width
;
756 by
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (header_line_height
,
758 ny
= row
->visible_height
;
763 if (bar_area_x
+ bar_area_width
== bx
)
765 bx
= bar_area_x
+ sb_width
;
766 nx
+= bar_area_width
- sb_width
;
768 else if (bx
+ nx
== bar_area_x
)
769 nx
+= bar_area_width
- sb_width
;
774 if (bx
>= 0 && nx
> 0)
775 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, face
->gc
, bx
, by
, nx
, ny
);
778 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->foreground
);
784 Pixmap pixmap
, clipmask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
785 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
));
789 bits
= (char *) (p
->bits
+ p
->dh
);
791 bits
= (char *) p
->bits
+ p
->dh
;
793 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
795 pixmap
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
, window
, bits
, p
->wd
, p
->h
,
797 ? (p
->overlay_p
? face
->background
798 : f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
800 face
->background
, depth
);
804 clipmask
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
,
805 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
,
808 gcv
.clip_mask
= clipmask
;
809 gcv
.clip_x_origin
= p
->x
;
810 gcv
.clip_y_origin
= p
->y
;
811 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
, &gcv
);
814 XCopyArea (display
, pixmap
, window
, gc
, 0, 0,
815 p
->wd
, p
->h
, p
->x
, p
->y
);
816 XFreePixmap (display
, pixmap
);
820 gcv
.clip_mask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
821 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
, &gcv
);
822 XFreePixmap (display
, clipmask
);
826 XSetClipMask (display
, gc
, None
);
829 /***********************************************************************
831 ***********************************************************************/
835 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string
*);
836 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
837 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
838 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
839 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string
*);
840 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*);
841 static _Noreturn
void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame
*, int);
842 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string
*);
843 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
844 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
845 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
846 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame
*, Display
*, Colormap
,
847 unsigned long *, double, int);
848 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame
*, struct relief
*,
849 double, int, unsigned long);
850 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string
*);
851 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*);
852 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string
*);
853 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
854 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string
*, Pixmap
);
855 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string
*, int,
857 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame
*, int, int, int, int,
858 int, int, int, int, int, int,
860 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string
*, int, int, int, int,
861 int, int, int, XRectangle
*);
862 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame
*);
865 static void x_check_font (struct frame
*, struct font
*);
869 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
873 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
875 if (s
->font
== FRAME_FONT (s
->f
)
876 && s
->face
->background
== FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
877 && s
->face
->foreground
== FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
879 s
->gc
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_gc
;
882 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
886 xgcv
.background
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
887 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
889 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
890 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
891 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
892 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
893 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
;
894 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
895 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
897 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
898 if (xgcv
.background
== s
->face
->background
899 && xgcv
.foreground
== s
->face
->foreground
)
901 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->foreground
;
902 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
905 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s
->f
, s
->font
));
906 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
907 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
909 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
910 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
913 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
914 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
916 s
->gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
921 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
924 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
929 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
930 face_id
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (s
->f
)->mouse_face_face_id
;
931 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
933 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, MOUSE_FACE_ID
);
935 if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
936 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, s
->first_glyph
->u
.ch
, -1, Qnil
);
938 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, 0, -1, Qnil
);
939 s
->face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
940 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s
->f
, s
->face
);
942 if (s
->font
== s
->face
->font
)
946 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
951 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->background
;
952 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
953 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
954 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
956 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
957 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
960 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
961 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
963 s
->gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
966 eassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
970 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
971 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
972 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
975 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
981 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
982 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
986 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
988 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s
->f
, s
->face
);
990 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
)
993 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
995 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO
)
997 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s
);
998 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1000 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
1002 x_set_cursor_gc (s
);
1005 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
)
1007 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
1008 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1010 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1011 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
1013 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1014 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1018 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1019 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1022 /* GC must have been set. */
1023 eassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
1027 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1028 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1031 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1033 XRectangle
*r
= s
->clip
;
1034 int n
= get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s
, r
, 2);
1037 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, r
, n
, Unsorted
);
1042 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1043 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1047 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string
*src
, struct glyph_string
*dst
)
1052 r
.width
= src
->width
;
1054 r
.height
= src
->height
;
1057 XSetClipRectangles (dst
->display
, dst
->gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
1062 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1065 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1068 && (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
1069 || s
->first_glyph
->type
== COMPOSITE_GLYPH
))
1071 struct font_metrics metrics
;
1073 if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
1075 unsigned *code
= alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s
->nchars
);
1076 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1079 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++)
1080 code
[i
] = (s
->char2b
[i
].byte1
<< 8) | s
->char2b
[i
].byte2
;
1081 font
->driver
->text_extents (font
, code
, s
->nchars
, &metrics
);
1085 Lisp_Object gstring
= composition_gstring_from_id (s
->cmp_id
);
1087 composition_gstring_width (gstring
, s
->cmp_from
, s
->cmp_to
, &metrics
);
1089 s
->right_overhang
= (metrics
.rbearing
> metrics
.width
1090 ? metrics
.rbearing
- metrics
.width
: 0);
1091 s
->left_overhang
= metrics
.lbearing
< 0 ? - metrics
.lbearing
: 0;
1095 s
->right_overhang
= s
->cmp
->rbearing
- s
->cmp
->pixel_width
;
1096 s
->left_overhang
= - s
->cmp
->lbearing
;
1101 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1104 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
, int x
, int y
, int w
, int h
)
1107 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
1108 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
1109 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
1110 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
1114 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1115 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1116 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1117 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1118 contains the first component of a composition. */
1121 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string
*s
, bool force_p
)
1123 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1124 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1125 if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
1127 int box_line_width
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
1131 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1132 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
1133 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
,
1134 s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1135 s
->background_width
,
1136 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1137 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
1138 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
1140 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s
->font
) < s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
1141 || s
->font_not_found_p
1142 || s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1145 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1146 s
->background_width
,
1147 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1148 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
1154 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1157 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1161 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1162 of S to the right of that box line. */
1163 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1164 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1165 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1169 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1171 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1173 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; ++i
)
1175 struct glyph
*g
= s
->first_glyph
+ i
;
1176 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
,
1177 s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
, g
->pixel_width
- 1,
1179 x
+= g
->pixel_width
;
1184 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1185 int boff
= font
->baseline_offset
;
1188 if (font
->vertical_centering
)
1189 boff
= VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font
, s
->f
) - boff
;
1191 y
= s
->ybase
- boff
;
1193 || (s
->background_filled_p
&& s
->hl
!= DRAW_CURSOR
))
1194 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
, y
, 0);
1196 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
, y
, 1);
1197 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1198 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1202 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1205 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1208 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1210 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1211 of S to the right of that box line. */
1212 if (s
->face
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1213 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1214 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1218 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1219 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1220 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1221 this composition. */
1223 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1224 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1225 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1227 if (s
->cmp_from
== 0)
1228 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
,
1229 s
->width
- 1, s
->height
- 1);
1231 else if (! s
->first_glyph
->u
.cmp
.automatic
)
1235 for (i
= 0, j
= s
->cmp_from
; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++, j
++)
1236 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1237 space on the left or right. */
1238 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s
->cmp
, j
) != '\t')
1240 int xx
= x
+ s
->cmp
->offsets
[j
* 2];
1241 int yy
= y
- s
->cmp
->offsets
[j
* 2 + 1];
1243 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, j
+ 1, xx
, yy
, 0);
1244 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1245 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, j
+ 1, xx
+ 1, yy
, 0);
1250 Lisp_Object gstring
= composition_gstring_from_id (s
->cmp_id
);
1255 for (i
= j
= s
->cmp_from
; i
< s
->cmp_to
; i
++)
1257 glyph
= LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring
, i
);
1258 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph
)))
1259 width
+= LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph
);
1262 int xoff
, yoff
, wadjust
;
1266 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
, y
, 0);
1267 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1268 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1271 xoff
= LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph
);
1272 yoff
= LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph
);
1273 wadjust
= LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph
);
1274 font
->driver
->draw (s
, i
, i
+ 1, x
+ xoff
, y
+ yoff
, 0);
1275 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1276 font
->driver
->draw (s
, i
, i
+ 1, x
+ xoff
+ 1, y
+ yoff
, 0);
1284 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
, y
, 0);
1285 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1286 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1292 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1295 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1297 struct glyph
*glyph
= s
->first_glyph
;
1301 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1302 of S to the right of that box line. */
1303 if (s
->face
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1304 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1305 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1311 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++, glyph
++)
1313 char buf
[7], *str
= NULL
;
1314 int len
= glyph
->u
.glyphless
.len
;
1316 if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
== GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM
)
1319 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display
)
1320 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display
))
1324 = (! glyph
->u
.glyphless
.for_no_font
1325 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display
,
1326 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
)
1327 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display
)->extras
[0]);
1328 if (STRINGP (acronym
))
1329 str
= SSDATA (acronym
);
1332 else if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
== GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE
)
1334 sprintf (buf
, "%0*X",
1335 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
< 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1336 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
);
1342 int upper_len
= (len
+ 1) / 2;
1345 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1346 for (j
= 0; j
< len
; j
++)
1348 code
= s
->font
->driver
->encode_char (s
->font
, str
[j
]);
1349 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b
+ j
, code
>> 8, code
& 0xFF);
1351 s
->font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, upper_len
,
1352 x
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.upper_xoff
,
1353 s
->ybase
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.upper_yoff
,
1355 s
->font
->driver
->draw (s
, upper_len
, len
,
1356 x
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.lower_xoff
,
1357 s
->ybase
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.lower_yoff
,
1360 if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
!= GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE
)
1361 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
1362 x
, s
->ybase
- glyph
->ascent
,
1363 glyph
->pixel_width
- 1,
1364 glyph
->ascent
+ glyph
->descent
- 1);
1365 x
+= glyph
->pixel_width
;
1369 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1373 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1374 cannot be determined. */
1376 static struct frame
*
1377 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget
)
1379 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
1380 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
1383 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget
));
1385 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1386 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1387 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1388 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1389 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget
))
1390 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
1392 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1393 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1394 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
1398 && f
->output_data
.nothing
!= 1
1399 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
1400 && f
->output_data
.x
->widget
== widget
)
1406 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1407 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1408 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1409 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1410 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1411 Value is true if successful. */
1414 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget
, Display
*display
, Colormap cmap
,
1415 unsigned long *pixel
, double factor
, int delta
)
1417 struct frame
*f
= x_frame_of_widget (widget
);
1418 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, display
, cmap
, pixel
, factor
, delta
);
1421 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1424 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1425 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1427 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args
[] =
1429 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.screen
),
1431 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.colormap
),
1436 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1437 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1439 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1442 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1444 DPY is the display we are working on.
1446 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1447 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1448 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1449 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1451 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1452 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1454 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1455 we allocated the color or not.
1457 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1460 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display
*dpy
, XrmValue
*args
, Cardinal
*nargs
,
1461 XrmValue
*from
, XrmValue
*to
,
1462 XtPointer
*closure_ret
)
1472 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1473 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1475 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL
, NULL
);
1479 screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1480 cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1481 color_name
= (String
) from
->addr
;
1483 if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultBackground
) == 0)
1485 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1486 pixel
= WhitePixelOfScreen (screen
);
1488 else if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultForeground
) == 0)
1490 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1491 pixel
= BlackPixelOfScreen (screen
);
1493 else if (XParseColor (dpy
, cmap
, color_name
, &color
)
1494 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy
, cmap
, &color
))
1496 pixel
= color
.pixel
;
1497 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) True
;
1502 Cardinal nparams
= 1;
1504 params
[0] = color_name
;
1505 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1506 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1507 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1512 if (to
->addr
!= NULL
)
1514 if (to
->size
< sizeof (Pixel
))
1516 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1520 *(Pixel
*) to
->addr
= pixel
;
1524 cvt_string_to_pixel_value
= pixel
;
1525 to
->addr
= (XtPointer
) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1528 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1533 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1534 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1535 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1537 APP is the application context in which we work.
1539 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1540 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1541 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1543 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1546 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app
, XrmValuePtr to
, XtPointer closure
, XrmValuePtr args
,
1551 XtAppWarningMsg (app
, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1553 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1556 else if (closure
!= NULL
)
1558 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1559 Screen
*screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1560 Colormap cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1561 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen
), screen
, cmap
,
1562 (Pixel
*) to
->addr
, 1);
1567 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1570 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1571 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1572 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1573 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1575 static const XColor
*
1576 x_color_cells (Display
*dpy
, int *ncells
)
1578 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1580 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
== NULL
)
1582 Screen
*screen
= dpyinfo
->screen
;
1583 int ncolor_cells
= XDisplayCells (dpy
, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen
));
1586 dpyinfo
->color_cells
= xnmalloc (ncolor_cells
,
1587 sizeof *dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1588 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
= ncolor_cells
;
1590 for (i
= 0; i
< ncolor_cells
; ++i
)
1591 dpyinfo
->color_cells
[i
].pixel
= i
;
1593 XQueryColors (dpy
, dpyinfo
->cmap
,
1594 dpyinfo
->color_cells
, ncolor_cells
);
1597 *ncells
= dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
;
1598 return dpyinfo
->color_cells
;
1602 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1603 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1606 x_query_colors (struct frame
*f
, XColor
*colors
, int ncolors
)
1608 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
1610 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
)
1613 for (i
= 0; i
< ncolors
; ++i
)
1615 unsigned long pixel
= colors
[i
].pixel
;
1616 eassert (pixel
< dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
);
1617 eassert (dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
].pixel
== pixel
);
1618 colors
[i
] = dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
];
1622 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), colors
, ncolors
);
1626 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1627 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1630 x_query_color (struct frame
*f
, XColor
*color
)
1632 x_query_colors (f
, color
, 1);
1636 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1637 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1638 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1642 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display
*dpy
, Colormap cmap
, XColor
*color
)
1646 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
) != 0;
1649 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1650 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1651 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1652 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1654 int max_color_delta
= 255;
1655 int max_delta
= 3 * max_color_delta
;
1656 int nearest_delta
= max_delta
+ 1;
1658 const XColor
*cells
= x_color_cells (dpy
, &ncells
);
1660 for (nearest
= i
= 0; i
< ncells
; ++i
)
1662 int dred
= (color
->red
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].red
>> 8);
1663 int dgreen
= (color
->green
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].green
>> 8);
1664 int dblue
= (color
->blue
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].blue
>> 8);
1665 int delta
= dred
* dred
+ dgreen
* dgreen
+ dblue
* dblue
;
1667 if (delta
< nearest_delta
)
1670 nearest_delta
= delta
;
1674 color
->red
= cells
[nearest
].red
;
1675 color
->green
= cells
[nearest
].green
;
1676 color
->blue
= cells
[nearest
].blue
;
1677 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
) != 0;
1681 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1682 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1683 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1684 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1685 XColor
*cached_color
;
1687 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
1688 && (cached_color
= &dpyinfo
->color_cells
[color
->pixel
],
1689 (cached_color
->red
!= color
->red
1690 || cached_color
->blue
!= color
->blue
1691 || cached_color
->green
!= color
->green
)))
1693 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1694 dpyinfo
->color_cells
= NULL
;
1695 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
= 0;
1699 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1701 register_color (color
->pixel
);
1702 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1708 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1709 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1710 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1714 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame
*f
, Colormap cmap
, XColor
*color
)
1716 gamma_correct (f
, color
);
1717 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), cmap
, color
);
1721 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1722 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1723 get color reference counts right. */
1726 x_copy_color (struct frame
*f
, long unsigned int pixel
)
1730 color
.pixel
= pixel
;
1732 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1733 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), &color
);
1735 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1736 register_color (pixel
);
1742 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1745 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1746 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1747 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1748 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1749 use an additional additive factor.
1751 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1752 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1753 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1756 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1757 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1758 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1759 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1760 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1761 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1764 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame
*f
, Display
*display
, Colormap cmap
, long unsigned int *pixel
, double factor
, int delta
)
1770 /* Get RGB color values. */
1771 color
.pixel
= *pixel
;
1772 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1774 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1775 eassert (factor
>= 0);
1776 new.red
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.red
);
1777 new.green
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.green
);
1778 new.blue
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.blue
);
1780 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1781 bright
= (2 * color
.red
+ 3 * color
.green
+ color
.blue
) / 6;
1783 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1784 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1785 if (bright
< HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
)
1786 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1787 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1789 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1790 double dimness
= 1 - (double)bright
/ HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
;
1791 /* The additive adjustment. */
1792 int min_delta
= delta
* dimness
* factor
/ 2;
1796 new.red
= max (0, new.red
- min_delta
);
1797 new.green
= max (0, new.green
- min_delta
);
1798 new.blue
= max (0, new.blue
- min_delta
);
1802 new.red
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.red
);
1803 new.green
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.green
);
1804 new.blue
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.blue
);
1808 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1809 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1812 if (new.pixel
== *pixel
)
1814 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1815 delta to the RGB values. */
1816 x_free_colors (f
, &new.pixel
, 1);
1818 new.red
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.red
);
1819 new.green
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.green
);
1820 new.blue
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.blue
);
1821 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1832 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1833 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1834 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1835 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1836 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1837 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1840 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame
*f
, struct relief
*relief
, double factor
, int delta
, long unsigned int default_pixel
)
1843 struct x_output
*di
= f
->output_data
.x
;
1844 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCLineWidth
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
1845 unsigned long pixel
;
1846 unsigned long background
= di
->relief_background
;
1847 Colormap cmap
= FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
);
1848 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
1849 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
1851 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
1852 xgcv
.line_width
= 1;
1854 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1855 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1856 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1858 && relief
->allocated_p
)
1860 x_free_colors (f
, &relief
->pixel
, 1);
1861 relief
->allocated_p
= 0;
1864 /* Allocate new color. */
1865 xgcv
.foreground
= default_pixel
;
1867 if (dpyinfo
->n_planes
!= 1
1868 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, dpy
, cmap
, &pixel
, factor
, delta
))
1870 relief
->allocated_p
= 1;
1871 xgcv
.foreground
= relief
->pixel
= pixel
;
1874 if (relief
->gc
== 0)
1876 xgcv
.stipple
= dpyinfo
->gray
;
1878 relief
->gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), mask
, &xgcv
);
1881 XChangeGC (dpy
, relief
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
1885 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1888 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1890 struct x_output
*di
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
;
1891 unsigned long color
;
1893 if (s
->face
->use_box_color_for_shadows_p
)
1894 color
= s
->face
->box_color
;
1895 else if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
1897 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0))
1898 color
= IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0);
1903 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1904 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
1905 color
= xgcv
.background
;
1908 if (di
->white_relief
.gc
== 0
1909 || color
!= di
->relief_background
)
1911 di
->relief_background
= color
;
1912 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->white_relief
, 1.2, 0x8000,
1913 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
1914 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->black_relief
, 0.6, 0x4000,
1915 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
1920 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1921 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1922 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1923 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1924 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1925 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1929 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame
*f
,
1930 int left_x
, int top_y
, int right_x
, int bottom_y
, int width
,
1931 int raised_p
, int top_p
, int bot_p
, int left_p
, int right_p
,
1932 XRectangle
*clip_rect
)
1934 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
1935 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
1940 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
1942 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
1943 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
1945 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1946 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1947 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1954 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1955 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), top_y
,
1956 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), top_y
);
1958 for (i
= 1; i
< width
; ++i
)
1959 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1960 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, top_y
+ i
,
1961 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, top_y
+ i
);
1968 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
, left_x
, top_y
+ 1, left_x
, bottom_y
);
1970 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, left_x
, top_y
, 1, 1, False
);
1971 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, left_x
, bottom_y
, 1, 1, False
);
1973 for (i
= (width
> 1 ? 1 : 0); i
< width
; ++i
)
1974 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1975 left_x
+ i
, top_y
+ (i
+ 1) * top_p
,
1976 left_x
+ i
, bottom_y
+ 1 - (i
+ 1) * bot_p
);
1979 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
1981 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
1983 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
1984 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
1988 /* Outermost top line. */
1990 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1991 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), top_y
,
1992 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), top_y
);
1994 /* Outermost left line. */
1996 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
, left_x
, top_y
+ 1, left_x
, bottom_y
);
2002 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2003 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), bottom_y
,
2004 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), bottom_y
);
2005 for (i
= 1; i
< width
; ++i
)
2006 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2007 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, bottom_y
- i
,
2008 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, bottom_y
- i
);
2014 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, right_x
, top_y
, 1, 1, False
);
2015 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, right_x
, bottom_y
, 1, 1, False
);
2016 for (i
= 0; i
< width
; ++i
)
2017 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2018 right_x
- i
, top_y
+ (i
+ 1) * top_p
,
2019 right_x
- i
, bottom_y
+ 1 - (i
+ 1) * bot_p
);
2022 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
2026 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2027 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2028 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2029 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2030 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2031 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2034 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
,
2035 int left_x
, int top_y
, int right_x
, int bottom_y
, int width
,
2036 int left_p
, int right_p
, XRectangle
*clip_rect
)
2040 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2041 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->box_color
);
2042 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
2045 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2046 left_x
, top_y
, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2050 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2051 left_x
, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2054 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2055 left_x
, bottom_y
- width
+ 1, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2059 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2060 right_x
- width
+ 1, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2062 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2063 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2067 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2070 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2072 int width
, left_x
, right_x
, top_y
, bottom_y
, last_x
, raised_p
;
2073 int left_p
, right_p
;
2074 struct glyph
*last_glyph
;
2075 XRectangle clip_rect
;
2077 last_x
= ((s
->row
->full_width_p
&& !s
->w
->pseudo_window_p
)
2078 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s
->w
)
2079 : window_box_right (s
->w
, s
->area
));
2081 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2082 last_glyph
= (s
->cmp
|| s
->img
2084 : s
->first_glyph
+ s
->nchars
- 1);
2086 width
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2087 raised_p
= s
->face
->box
== FACE_RAISED_BOX
;
2089 right_x
= (s
->row
->full_width_p
&& s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2091 : min (last_x
, s
->x
+ s
->background_width
) - 1);
2093 bottom_y
= top_y
+ s
->height
- 1;
2095 left_p
= (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2096 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2098 || s
->prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2099 right_p
= (last_glyph
->right_box_line_p
2100 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2102 || s
->next
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2104 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2106 if (s
->face
->box
== FACE_SIMPLE_BOX
)
2107 x_draw_box_rect (s
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
, width
,
2108 left_p
, right_p
, &clip_rect
);
2111 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2112 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
,
2113 width
, raised_p
, 1, 1, left_p
, right_p
, &clip_rect
);
2118 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2121 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2124 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2126 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2127 right of that line. */
2128 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2129 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2131 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2133 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2135 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2136 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2137 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2138 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2144 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2145 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2146 trust on the shape extension to be available
2147 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2149 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2152 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2154 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2155 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
;
2156 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
;
2157 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2158 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2160 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2163 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2164 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2165 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2166 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2167 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2168 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2172 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2174 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2177 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2178 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2179 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2180 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2181 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2182 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2184 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2185 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2186 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2187 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2188 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2189 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2190 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2192 int relief
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2193 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2194 x
- relief
, y
- relief
,
2195 s
->slice
.width
+ relief
*2 - 1,
2196 s
->slice
.height
+ relief
*2 - 1);
2201 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2202 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2203 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2207 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2210 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2212 int x1
, y1
, thick
, raised_p
, top_p
, bot_p
, left_p
, right_p
;
2215 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2217 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2218 right of that line. */
2219 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2220 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2222 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2224 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2226 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2227 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2228 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2229 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2231 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2232 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
)
2234 thick
= tool_bar_button_relief
>= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief
: DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF
;
2235 raised_p
= s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
;
2239 thick
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2240 raised_p
= s
->img
->relief
> 0;
2243 x1
= x
+ s
->slice
.width
- 1;
2244 y1
= y
+ s
->slice
.height
- 1;
2245 top_p
= bot_p
= left_p
= right_p
= 0;
2247 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2248 x
-= thick
, left_p
= 1;
2249 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2250 y
-= thick
, top_p
= 1;
2251 if (s
->slice
.x
+ s
->slice
.width
== s
->img
->width
)
2252 x1
+= thick
, right_p
= 1;
2253 if (s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
== s
->img
->height
)
2254 y1
+= thick
, bot_p
= 1;
2256 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2257 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2258 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, x
, y
, x1
, y1
, thick
, raised_p
,
2259 top_p
, bot_p
, left_p
, right_p
, &r
);
2263 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2266 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string
*s
, Pixmap pixmap
)
2269 int y
= s
->ybase
- s
->y
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2271 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2272 right of that line. */
2273 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2274 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2276 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2278 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2280 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2281 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2282 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2283 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2289 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2290 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2291 trust on the shape extension to be available
2292 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2294 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2298 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2299 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
- s
->slice
.x
;
2300 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
- s
->slice
.y
;
2301 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2302 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2304 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2305 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2306 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2307 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2311 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2312 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2313 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2315 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2316 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2317 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2318 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2319 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2320 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2321 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2323 int r
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2324 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
- r
, y
- r
,
2325 s
->slice
.width
+ r
*2 - 1,
2326 s
->slice
.height
+ r
*2 - 1);
2331 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2332 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2333 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2337 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2338 give the rectangle to draw. */
2341 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
, int x
, int y
, int w
, int h
)
2345 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2346 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2347 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2348 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2351 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2355 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2358 s->x +-------------------------
2361 | +-------------------------
2364 | | +-------------------
2370 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2372 int box_line_hwidth
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2373 int box_line_vwidth
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
2375 Pixmap pixmap
= None
;
2378 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2379 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2380 if (s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
>= s
->img
->height
)
2381 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2383 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2384 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2386 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
2387 if (height
> s
->slice
.height
2391 || s
->img
->pixmap
== 0
2392 || s
->width
!= s
->background_width
)
2396 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2397 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2398 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2399 Screen
*screen
= FRAME_X_SCREEN (s
->f
);
2400 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen
);
2402 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2403 pixmap
= XCreatePixmap (s
->display
, s
->window
,
2404 s
->background_width
,
2407 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2409 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2411 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2414 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2415 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2416 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, - s
->x
, - s
->y
);
2417 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2418 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2419 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2420 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0);
2425 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
,
2427 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2428 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2429 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2430 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2438 if (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2440 x
+= box_line_hwidth
;
2442 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2443 y
+= box_line_vwidth
;
2445 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, y
, s
->background_width
, height
);
2448 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2451 /* Draw the foreground. */
2454 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s
, pixmap
);
2455 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2456 XCopyArea (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2457 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
, s
->x
, s
->y
);
2458 XFreePixmap (s
->display
, pixmap
);
2461 x_draw_image_foreground (s
);
2463 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2465 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2466 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
2467 x_draw_image_relief (s
);
2471 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2474 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2476 eassert (s
->first_glyph
->type
== STRETCH_GLYPH
);
2478 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
2479 && !x_stretch_cursor_p
)
2481 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2482 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2483 int width
, background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2486 if (!s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2488 int left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2492 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2498 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2500 int right_x
= window_box_right_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2502 if (x
+ background_width
> right_x
)
2503 background_width
-= x
- right_x
;
2504 x
+= background_width
;
2506 width
= min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s
->f
), background_width
);
2507 if (s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2511 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, width
, s
->height
);
2513 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2514 if (width
< background_width
)
2517 int w
= background_width
- width
, h
= s
->height
;
2521 if (!s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2525 if (s
->row
->mouse_face_p
2526 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s
->w
))
2528 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
2534 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2535 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
2537 if (s
->face
->stipple
)
2539 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2540 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2541 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2542 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillSolid
);
2547 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
2548 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2549 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2550 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2554 else if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
2556 int background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2557 int x
= s
->x
, left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2559 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2560 except for header line and mode line. */
2561 if (x
< left_x
&& !s
->row
->mode_line_p
)
2563 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2566 if (background_width
> 0)
2567 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, background_width
, s
->height
);
2570 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2574 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2580 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2585 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2587 int wave_height
= 3, wave_length
= 2;
2588 int dx
, dy
, x0
, y0
, width
, x1
, y1
, x2
, y2
, odd
, xmax
;
2589 XRectangle wave_clip
, string_clip
, final_clip
;
2592 dy
= wave_height
- 1;
2594 y0
= s
->ybase
- wave_height
+ 3;
2598 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2602 wave_clip
.width
= width
;
2603 wave_clip
.height
= wave_height
;
2604 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &string_clip
);
2606 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip
, &string_clip
, &final_clip
))
2609 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, &final_clip
, 1, Unsorted
);
2611 /* Draw the waves */
2613 x1
= x0
- (x0
% dx
);
2623 if (INT_MAX
- dx
< xmax
)
2628 XDrawLine (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x1
, y1
, x2
, y2
);
2630 x2
+= dx
, y2
= y0
+ odd
*dy
;
2634 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2635 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, s
->clip
, s
->num_clips
, Unsorted
);
2639 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2642 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2644 bool relief_drawn_p
= 0;
2646 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2647 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2648 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2649 if (s
->next
&& s
->right_overhang
&& !s
->for_overlaps
)
2652 struct glyph_string
*next
;
2654 for (width
= 0, next
= s
->next
;
2655 next
&& width
< s
->right_overhang
;
2656 width
+= next
->width
, next
= next
->next
)
2657 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
!= IMAGE_GLYPH
)
2659 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next
);
2660 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next
);
2661 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
== STRETCH_GLYPH
)
2662 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next
);
2664 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next
, 1);
2665 next
->num_clips
= 0;
2669 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2670 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s
);
2672 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2673 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2674 if (!s
->for_overlaps
2675 && s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2676 && (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
2677 || s
->first_glyph
->type
== COMPOSITE_GLYPH
))
2680 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2681 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2682 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2683 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2686 else if (!s
->clip_head
/* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2688 && ((s
->prev
&& s
->prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
&& s
->left_overhang
)
2689 || (s
->next
&& s
->next
->hl
!= s
->hl
&& s
->right_overhang
)))
2690 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2691 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2692 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2693 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, s
);
2695 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2697 switch (s
->first_glyph
->type
)
2700 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s
);
2704 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s
);
2708 if (s
->for_overlaps
)
2709 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2711 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 0);
2712 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2715 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH
:
2716 if (s
->for_overlaps
|| (s
->cmp_from
> 0
2717 && ! s
->first_glyph
->u
.cmp
.automatic
))
2718 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2720 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2721 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2724 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
:
2725 if (s
->for_overlaps
)
2726 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2728 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2729 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2736 if (!s
->for_overlaps
)
2738 /* Draw underline. */
2739 if (s
->face
->underline_p
)
2741 if (s
->face
->underline_type
== FACE_UNDER_WAVE
)
2743 if (s
->face
->underline_defaulted_p
)
2744 x_draw_underwave (s
);
2748 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2749 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->underline_color
);
2750 x_draw_underwave (s
);
2751 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2754 else if (s
->face
->underline_type
== FACE_UNDER_LINE
)
2756 unsigned long thickness
, position
;
2759 if (s
->prev
&& s
->prev
->face
->underline_p
2760 && s
->prev
->face
->underline_type
== FACE_UNDER_LINE
)
2762 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2763 thickness
= s
->prev
->underline_thickness
;
2764 position
= s
->prev
->underline_position
;
2768 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2769 if (s
->font
&& s
->font
->underline_thickness
> 0)
2770 thickness
= s
->font
->underline_thickness
;
2773 if (x_underline_at_descent_line
)
2774 position
= (s
->height
- thickness
) - (s
->ybase
- s
->y
);
2777 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2778 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2779 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2780 specs, and its default is
2782 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2783 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2785 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2786 && s
->font
&& s
->font
->underline_position
>= 0)
2787 position
= s
->font
->underline_position
;
2789 position
= (s
->font
->descent
+ 1) / 2;
2791 position
= underline_minimum_offset
;
2793 position
= max (position
, underline_minimum_offset
);
2795 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2796 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2797 if (s
->y
+ s
->height
<= s
->ybase
+ position
)
2798 position
= (s
->height
- 1) - (s
->ybase
- s
->y
);
2799 if (s
->y
+ s
->height
< s
->ybase
+ position
+ thickness
)
2800 thickness
= (s
->y
+ s
->height
) - (s
->ybase
+ position
);
2801 s
->underline_thickness
= thickness
;
2802 s
->underline_position
= position
;
2803 y
= s
->ybase
+ position
;
2804 if (s
->face
->underline_defaulted_p
)
2805 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2806 s
->x
, y
, s
->width
, thickness
);
2810 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2811 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->underline_color
);
2812 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2813 s
->x
, y
, s
->width
, thickness
);
2814 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2818 /* Draw overline. */
2819 if (s
->face
->overline_p
)
2821 unsigned long dy
= 0, h
= 1;
2823 if (s
->face
->overline_color_defaulted_p
)
2824 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2829 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2830 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->overline_color
);
2831 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2833 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2837 /* Draw strike-through. */
2838 if (s
->face
->strike_through_p
)
2840 unsigned long h
= 1;
2841 unsigned long dy
= (s
->height
- h
) / 2;
2843 if (s
->face
->strike_through_color_defaulted_p
)
2844 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2849 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2850 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->strike_through_color
);
2851 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2853 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2857 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2858 if (!relief_drawn_p
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
)
2859 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2863 struct glyph_string
*prev
;
2865 for (prev
= s
->prev
; prev
; prev
= prev
->prev
)
2866 if (prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
2867 && prev
->x
+ prev
->width
+ prev
->right_overhang
> s
->x
)
2869 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2870 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2871 enum draw_glyphs_face save
= prev
->hl
;
2874 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev
);
2875 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, prev
);
2876 if (prev
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
2877 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev
);
2879 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev
);
2880 XSetClipMask (prev
->display
, prev
->gc
, None
);
2882 prev
->num_clips
= 0;
2888 struct glyph_string
*next
;
2890 for (next
= s
->next
; next
; next
= next
->next
)
2891 if (next
->hl
!= s
->hl
2892 && next
->x
- next
->left_overhang
< s
->x
+ s
->width
)
2894 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2895 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2896 enum draw_glyphs_face save
= next
->hl
;
2899 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next
);
2900 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, next
);
2901 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
2902 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next
);
2904 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next
);
2905 XSetClipMask (next
->display
, next
->gc
, None
);
2907 next
->num_clips
= 0;
2908 next
->clip_head
= s
->next
;
2913 /* Reset clipping. */
2914 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2918 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2921 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
, int shift_by
)
2923 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
2924 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
2925 x
, y
, width
, height
,
2929 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2933 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame
*f
, register int n
)
2939 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2940 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2943 x_clear_area (Display
*dpy
, Window window
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
)
2945 eassert (width
> 0 && height
> 0);
2946 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, x
, y
, width
, height
, False
);
2950 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2953 x_clear_frame (struct frame
*f
)
2955 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2957 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f
)));
2961 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
2963 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2964 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2965 x_scroll_bar_clear (f
);
2967 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2968 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2969 redisplay, do it here. */
2970 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
2971 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
2974 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
2981 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2984 XTflash (struct frame
*f
)
2990 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
2991 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
2992 GdkWindow
*window
= gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
2994 cairo_t
*cr
= gdk_cairo_create (window
);
2995 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr
, 1, 1, 1);
2996 cairo_set_operator (cr
, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE
);
2997 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
2999 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3003 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3006 vals
.foreground
.pixel
= (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
)
3007 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
3008 vals
.function
= GDK_XOR
;
3009 gc
= gdk_gc_new_with_values (window
,
3010 &vals
, GDK_GC_FUNCTION
| GDK_GC_FOREGROUND
);
3011 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3012 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3013 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3014 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3017 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3018 pixels into background pixels. */
3022 values
.function
= GXxor
;
3023 values
.foreground
= (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
)
3024 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
3026 gc
= XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3027 GCFunction
| GCForeground
, &values
);
3031 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3032 int height
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, FRAME_LINES (f
));
3033 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3034 int flash_height
= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
3035 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3036 int flash_left
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
3037 int flash_right
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
3041 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3042 edge it is next to. */
3043 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f
))
3045 case vertical_scroll_bar_left
:
3046 flash_left
+= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
3049 case vertical_scroll_bar_right
:
3050 flash_right
-= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
3057 width
= flash_right
- flash_left
;
3059 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3060 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3062 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3064 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3065 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
)),
3066 width
, flash_height
);
3067 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3069 (height
- flash_height
3070 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3071 width
, flash_height
);
3075 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3076 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3077 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3078 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3083 struct timespec delay
= make_timespec (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3084 struct timespec wakeup
= timespec_add (current_timespec (), delay
);
3086 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3088 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3090 struct timespec current
= current_timespec ();
3091 struct timespec timeout
;
3093 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3094 if (timespec_cmp (wakeup
, current
) <= 0)
3097 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3098 timeout
= make_timespec (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3100 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3101 pselect (0, NULL
, NULL
, NULL
, &timeout
, NULL
);
3105 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3106 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3108 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3110 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3111 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
)),
3112 width
, flash_height
);
3113 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3115 (height
- flash_height
3116 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3117 width
, flash_height
);
3120 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3121 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3122 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3123 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3129 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc
));
3131 #undef XFillRectangle
3133 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
);
3144 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (struct frame
*f
, int invisible
)
3149 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->invisible_cursor
!= 0)
3150 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3151 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->invisible_cursor
);
3154 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3155 f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
);
3156 f
->pointer_invisible
= invisible
;
3161 /* Make audible bell. */
3164 XTring_bell (struct frame
*f
)
3166 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))
3174 XkbBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, 0, None
);
3176 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), 0);
3178 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3184 /***********************************************************************
3186 ***********************************************************************/
3188 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3189 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3192 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame
*f
, int vpos
, int n
)
3198 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3201 x_scroll_run (struct window
*w
, struct run
*run
)
3203 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
3204 int x
, y
, width
, height
, from_y
, to_y
, bottom_y
;
3206 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3207 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3209 window_box (w
, ANY_AREA
, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
);
3211 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3212 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3213 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3214 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3215 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
)
3216 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
3217 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
)
3218 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
)))
3220 int sb_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
);
3224 int bar_area_x
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
3225 int bar_area_width
= (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
)
3226 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
));
3228 if (bar_area_x
+ bar_area_width
== x
)
3230 x
= bar_area_x
+ sb_width
;
3231 width
+= bar_area_width
- sb_width
;
3233 else if (x
+ width
== bar_area_x
)
3234 width
+= bar_area_width
- sb_width
;
3239 from_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->current_y
);
3240 to_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->desired_y
);
3241 bottom_y
= y
+ height
;
3245 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3246 line at the bottom. */
3247 if (from_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3248 height
= bottom_y
- from_y
;
3250 height
= run
->height
;
3254 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3256 if (to_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3257 height
= bottom_y
- to_y
;
3259 height
= run
->height
;
3264 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3267 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
3268 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3269 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
3279 /***********************************************************************
3281 ***********************************************************************/
3285 frame_highlight (struct frame
*f
)
3287 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3288 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3289 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3290 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3292 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3293 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3294 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3295 because of this (bug#9310). */
3296 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3297 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3298 f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
3299 x_uncatch_errors ();
3301 x_update_cursor (f
, 1);
3302 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
3306 frame_unhighlight (struct frame
*f
)
3308 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3309 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3310 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3311 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3313 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3314 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3315 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3316 f
->output_data
.x
->border_tile
);
3317 x_uncatch_errors ();
3319 x_update_cursor (f
, 1);
3320 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
3323 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3324 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3325 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3326 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3327 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3330 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
)
3332 struct frame
*old_focus
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3334 if (frame
!= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3336 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3337 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3338 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= frame
;
3340 if (old_focus
&& old_focus
->auto_lower
)
3341 x_lower_frame (old_focus
);
3343 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
&& dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
->auto_raise
)
3344 pending_autoraise_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3346 pending_autoraise_frame
= 0;
3349 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo
);
3352 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3353 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3354 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3357 x_focus_changed (int type
, int state
, struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
, struct input_event
*bufp
)
3359 if (type
== FocusIn
)
3361 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
!= frame
)
3363 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, frame
);
3364 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= frame
;
3366 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3367 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3368 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3369 bufp
->arg
= (((NILP (Vterminal_frame
) || EQ (Fdaemonp (), Qt
))
3370 && CONSP (Vframe_list
)
3371 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
3373 bufp
->kind
= FOCUS_IN_EVENT
;
3374 XSETFRAME (bufp
->frame_or_window
, frame
);
3377 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
|= state
;
3380 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3381 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3384 else if (type
== FocusOut
)
3386 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
&= ~state
;
3388 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
== frame
)
3390 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
3391 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, 0);
3393 bufp
->kind
= FOCUS_OUT_EVENT
;
3394 XSETFRAME (bufp
->frame_or_window
, frame
);
3398 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3399 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3401 if (frame
->pointer_invisible
)
3402 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame
, 0);
3406 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3407 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3409 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3412 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, XEvent
*event
, struct input_event
*bufp
)
3414 struct frame
*frame
;
3416 frame
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xany
.window
);
3420 switch (event
->type
)
3425 struct frame
*focus_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
;
3427 = focus_frame
? focus_frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
: 0;
3429 if (event
->xcrossing
.detail
!= NotifyInferior
3430 && event
->xcrossing
.focus
3431 && ! (focus_state
& FOCUS_EXPLICIT
))
3432 x_focus_changed ((event
->type
== EnterNotify
? FocusIn
: FocusOut
),
3434 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3440 x_focus_changed (event
->type
,
3441 (event
->xfocus
.detail
== NotifyPointer
?
3442 FOCUS_IMPLICIT
: FOCUS_EXPLICIT
),
3443 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3447 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
)
3449 enum xembed_message msg
= event
->xclient
.data
.l
[1];
3450 x_focus_changed ((msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_IN
? FocusIn
: FocusOut
),
3451 FOCUS_EXPLICIT
, dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3458 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3459 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3462 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3464 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
);
3468 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3469 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3470 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3472 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3473 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3474 the appropriate X display info. */
3477 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame
*frame
)
3479 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame
));
3483 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3485 struct frame
*old_highlight
= dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
;
3487 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3489 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
3490 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)))
3491 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
))
3492 : dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
);
3493 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
))
3495 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
, Qnil
);
3496 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3500 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
3502 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
!= old_highlight
)
3505 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight
);
3506 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
3507 frame_highlight (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
);
3513 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3515 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3517 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3519 int min_code
, max_code
;
3522 XModifierKeymap
*mods
;
3524 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= 0;
3525 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= 0;
3526 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3527 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
= 0;
3528 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
= 0;
3530 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo
->display
, &min_code
, &max_code
);
3532 syms
= XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo
->display
,
3533 min_code
, max_code
- min_code
+ 1,
3535 mods
= XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo
->display
);
3537 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3538 Alt keysyms are on. */
3540 int row
, col
; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3541 int found_alt_or_meta
;
3543 for (row
= 3; row
< 8; row
++)
3545 found_alt_or_meta
= 0;
3546 for (col
= 0; col
< mods
->max_keypermod
; col
++)
3548 KeyCode code
= mods
->modifiermap
[(row
* mods
->max_keypermod
) + col
];
3550 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3554 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3558 for (code_col
= 0; code_col
< syms_per_code
; code_col
++)
3560 int sym
= syms
[((code
- min_code
) * syms_per_code
) + code_col
];
3566 found_alt_or_meta
= 1;
3567 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3572 found_alt_or_meta
= 1;
3573 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3578 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3579 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3580 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3581 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3586 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3587 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3588 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3589 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3593 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3594 if (!found_alt_or_meta
&& ((1 << row
) == LockMask
))
3595 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= LockMask
;
3596 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3597 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3606 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3607 if (! dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3609 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
;
3610 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3613 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3614 make them just meta, not alt. */
3615 if (dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3617 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
&= ~dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
;
3621 XFreeModifiermap (mods
);
3624 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3628 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, int state
)
3630 int mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3631 int mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3632 int mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3633 int mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3636 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3637 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_alt
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3638 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3639 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_meta
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3640 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3641 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_hyper
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3642 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3643 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_super
= XINT (tem
) & INT_MAX
;
3645 return ( ((state
& (ShiftMask
| dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
)) ? shift_modifier
: 0)
3646 | ((state
& ControlMask
) ? ctrl_modifier
: 0)
3647 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
) ? mod_meta
: 0)
3648 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
) ? mod_alt
: 0)
3649 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
) ? mod_super
: 0)
3650 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
) ? mod_hyper
: 0));
3654 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, EMACS_INT state
)
3656 EMACS_INT mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3657 EMACS_INT mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3658 EMACS_INT mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3659 EMACS_INT mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3663 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3664 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_alt
= XINT (tem
);
3665 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3666 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_meta
= XINT (tem
);
3667 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3668 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_hyper
= XINT (tem
);
3669 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3670 if (INTEGERP (tem
)) mod_super
= XINT (tem
);
3673 return ( ((state
& mod_alt
) ? dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
: 0)
3674 | ((state
& mod_super
) ? dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
: 0)
3675 | ((state
& mod_hyper
) ? dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
: 0)
3676 | ((state
& shift_modifier
) ? ShiftMask
: 0)
3677 | ((state
& ctrl_modifier
) ? ControlMask
: 0)
3678 | ((state
& mod_meta
) ? dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
: 0));
3681 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3684 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym
)
3689 value
= XKeysymToString (keysym
);
3697 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3699 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3701 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3705 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event
*result
, XButtonEvent
*event
, struct frame
*f
)
3707 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3709 result
->kind
= MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT
;
3710 result
->code
= event
->button
- Button1
;
3711 result
->timestamp
= event
->time
;
3712 result
->modifiers
= (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
3714 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
3718 XSETINT (result
->x
, event
->x
);
3719 XSETINT (result
->y
, event
->y
);
3720 XSETFRAME (result
->frame_or_window
, f
);
3725 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3726 The input handler calls this.
3728 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3729 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3730 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3731 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3733 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event
;
3734 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame
;
3737 note_mouse_movement (struct frame
*frame
, XMotionEvent
*event
)
3739 last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->time
;
3740 last_mouse_motion_event
= *event
;
3741 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
, frame
);
3743 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame
))
3746 if (event
->window
!= FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame
))
3748 frame
->mouse_moved
= 1;
3749 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3750 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, -1, -1);
3751 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= 0;
3756 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3757 if (frame
!= last_mouse_glyph_frame
3758 || event
->x
< last_mouse_glyph
.x
3759 || event
->x
>= last_mouse_glyph
.x
+ last_mouse_glyph
.width
3760 || event
->y
< last_mouse_glyph
.y
3761 || event
->y
>= last_mouse_glyph
.y
+ last_mouse_glyph
.height
)
3763 frame
->mouse_moved
= 1;
3764 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3765 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
);
3766 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3767 remember_mouse_glyph (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
, &last_mouse_glyph
);
3768 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= frame
;
3776 /************************************************************************
3778 ************************************************************************/
3781 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3783 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame
)
3784 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
)))
3785 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
),
3786 last_mouse_motion_event
.x
,
3787 last_mouse_motion_event
.y
);
3792 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3793 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3795 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3796 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3797 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3798 position on the scroll bar.
3800 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3801 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3804 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3805 was at this position.
3807 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3809 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3813 XTmouse_position (struct frame
**fp
, int insist
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
,
3814 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
, Lisp_Object
*y
,
3821 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar
) && insist
== 0)
3822 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp
, bar_window
, part
, x
, y
, timestamp
);
3828 Window dummy_window
;
3831 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
3833 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3834 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3835 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
3836 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
))
3837 XFRAME (frame
)->mouse_moved
= 0;
3839 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3841 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3842 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3843 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)),
3845 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3848 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3849 a different screen. */
3852 /* The position on that root window. */
3855 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3858 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3860 (unsigned int *) &dummy
);
3862 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3863 containing the pointer. */
3867 int parent_x
= 0, parent_y
= 0;
3871 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3872 structure is changing at the same time this function
3873 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3875 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
));
3877 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
)->grabbed
&& last_mouse_frame
3878 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
3880 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3881 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3882 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3884 /* From-window, to-window. */
3885 root
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame
),
3887 /* From-position, to-position. */
3888 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
3892 f1
= last_mouse_frame
;
3898 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3900 /* From-window, to-window. */
3903 /* From-position, to-position. */
3904 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
3909 if (child
== None
|| child
== win
)
3912 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3913 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3914 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3915 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3916 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
), win
))
3924 /* Now we know that:
3925 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3926 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3927 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3928 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3929 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3930 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3931 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3932 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3933 never use them in that case.) */
3936 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3937 want the edit window. */
3938 f1
= x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
), win
);
3940 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3941 f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
), win
);
3944 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3945 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3948 && f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
3949 && win
== XtWindow (f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
))
3951 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3954 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)))
3957 x_uncatch_errors ();
3959 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3962 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
3964 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
), win
);
3968 f1
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
3974 if (f1
== 0 && insist
> 0)
3975 f1
= SELECTED_FRAME ();
3979 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3980 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3981 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3982 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3983 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3984 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3985 the frame are divided into. */
3987 remember_mouse_glyph (f1
, win_x
, win_y
, &last_mouse_glyph
);
3988 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= f1
;
3993 XSETINT (*x
, win_x
);
3994 XSETINT (*y
, win_y
);
3995 *timestamp
= last_mouse_movement_time
;
4005 /***********************************************************************
4007 ***********************************************************************/
4009 /* Scroll bar support. */
4011 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4013 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4016 static struct scroll_bar
*
4017 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display
*display
, Window window_id
)
4019 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
4021 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4022 window_id
= (Window
) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display
, window_id
);
4023 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4025 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
4027 Lisp_Object bar
, condemned
;
4029 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
4032 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4034 condemned
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
4035 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
4036 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4037 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4038 ! NILP (bar
) || (bar
= condemned
,
4041 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
4042 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
== window_id
&&
4043 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == display
)
4044 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
4051 #if defined USE_LUCID
4053 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4054 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4057 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window
)
4059 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
4061 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
4062 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
4064 Widget menu_bar
= XFRAME (frame
)->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
;
4066 if (menu_bar
&& xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar
, window
))
4072 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4075 /************************************************************************
4077 ************************************************************************/
4079 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4081 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent
*, struct input_event
*);
4082 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object
, int, int, int);
4083 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*,
4084 struct scroll_bar
*);
4085 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*,
4089 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4090 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4092 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled
;
4094 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4096 static int last_scroll_bar_part
;
4098 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4099 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4102 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4104 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id
;
4106 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll
;
4108 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4109 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4110 to avoid jerkiness. */
4112 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top
;
4114 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4115 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4116 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4117 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4120 xt_action_hook (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, String action_name
,
4121 XEvent
*event
, String
*params
, Cardinal
*num_params
)
4124 const char *end_action
;
4127 scroll_bar_p
= XmIsScrollBar (widget
);
4128 end_action
= "Release";
4129 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4130 scroll_bar_p
= XtIsSubclass (widget
, scrollbarWidgetClass
);
4131 end_action
= "EndScroll";
4132 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4135 && strcmp (action_name
, end_action
) == 0
4136 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4140 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4141 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0);
4142 w
= XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled
);
4144 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
)->dragging
))
4146 XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
)->dragging
= Qnil
;
4147 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4148 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w
);
4150 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4151 last_scroll_bar_part
= -1;
4153 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4154 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= 0;
4157 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4159 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4160 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4162 static struct window
**scroll_bar_windows
;
4163 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size
;
4166 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4167 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4168 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4169 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4172 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window
, int part
, int portion
, int whole
)
4175 XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= (XClientMessageEvent
*) &event
;
4176 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (window
);
4177 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4182 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4183 ev
->type
= ClientMessage
;
4184 ev
->message_type
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_Scrollbar
;
4185 ev
->display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
4186 ev
->window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
4189 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4190 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4191 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4192 into that array in the event. */
4193 for (i
= 0; i
< scroll_bar_windows_size
; ++i
)
4194 if (scroll_bar_windows
[i
] == NULL
)
4197 if (i
== scroll_bar_windows_size
)
4199 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes
=
4200 scroll_bar_windows_size
* sizeof *scroll_bar_windows
;
4202 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX
= 0x7fffffff };
4203 scroll_bar_windows
=
4204 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows
, &scroll_bar_windows_size
, 1,
4205 XClientMessageEvent_MAX
, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows
);
4206 nbytes
= scroll_bar_windows_size
* sizeof *scroll_bar_windows
;
4207 memset (&scroll_bar_windows
[i
], 0, nbytes
- old_nbytes
);
4210 scroll_bar_windows
[i
] = w
;
4211 ev
->data
.l
[0] = (long) i
;
4212 ev
->data
.l
[1] = (long) part
;
4213 ev
->data
.l
[2] = (long) 0;
4214 ev
->data
.l
[3] = (long) portion
;
4215 ev
->data
.l
[4] = (long) whole
;
4217 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4218 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4219 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= 1;
4220 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4223 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4224 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4225 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4226 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), False
, 0, &event
);
4231 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4235 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent
*event
, struct input_event
*ievent
)
4237 XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= (XClientMessageEvent
*) event
;
4241 w
= scroll_bar_windows
[ev
->data
.l
[0]];
4242 scroll_bar_windows
[ev
->data
.l
[0]] = NULL
;
4244 XSETWINDOW (window
, w
);
4246 ievent
->kind
= SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
4247 ievent
->frame_or_window
= window
;
4250 ievent
->timestamp
= CurrentTime
;
4253 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w
->frame
)));
4255 ievent
->part
= ev
->data
.l
[1];
4256 ievent
->code
= ev
->data
.l
[2];
4257 ievent
->x
= make_number ((int) ev
->data
.l
[3]);
4258 ievent
->y
= make_number ((int) ev
->data
.l
[4]);
4259 ievent
->modifiers
= 0;
4265 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4267 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4270 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4271 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4272 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4275 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4277 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= client_data
;
4278 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct
*cs
= call_data
;
4279 int part
= -1, whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4283 case XmCR_DECREMENT
:
4284 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4285 part
= scroll_bar_up_arrow
;
4288 case XmCR_INCREMENT
:
4289 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4290 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4293 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT
:
4294 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4295 part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4298 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT
:
4299 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4300 part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4304 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4305 part
= scroll_bar_to_top
;
4308 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM
:
4309 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4310 part
= scroll_bar_to_bottom
;
4317 /* Get the slider size. */
4319 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XmNsliderSize
, &slider_size
, NULL
);
4322 whole
= XM_SB_MAX
- slider_size
;
4323 portion
= min (cs
->value
, whole
);
4324 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4325 bar
->dragging
= make_number (cs
->value
);
4329 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED
:
4335 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4336 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4337 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4341 #elif defined USE_GTK
4343 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4344 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4347 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange
*range
,
4348 GtkScrollType scroll
,
4352 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= user_data
;
4354 int part
= -1, whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4355 GtkAdjustment
*adj
= GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range
));
4356 struct frame
*f
= g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range
), XG_FRAME_DATA
);
4358 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar
) return FALSE
;
4359 position
= gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj
);
4364 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP
:
4365 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4366 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->grabbed
!= 0
4367 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->grabbed
< (1 << 4))
4369 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4370 whole
= gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj
) -
4371 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj
);
4372 portion
= min ((int)position
, whole
);
4373 bar
->dragging
= make_number ((int)portion
);
4376 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD
:
4377 part
= scroll_bar_up_arrow
;
4378 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4380 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD
:
4381 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4382 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4384 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD
:
4385 part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4386 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4388 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD
:
4389 part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4390 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4396 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4397 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4398 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4404 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4407 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget
*widget
,
4408 GdkEventButton
*event
,
4411 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= user_data
;
4412 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4413 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4415 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4416 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0);
4417 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4424 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4426 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4427 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4428 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4432 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4434 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= client_data
;
4435 float *top_addr
= call_data
;
4436 float top
= *top_addr
;
4438 int whole
, portion
, height
;
4441 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4443 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNshown
, &shown
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4447 portion
= shown
< 1 ? top
* whole
: 0;
4449 if (shown
< 1 && (eabs (top
+ shown
- 1) < 1.0f
/ height
))
4450 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4451 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4452 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4453 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4455 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4457 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4459 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4460 bar
->dragging
= make_number (portion
);
4461 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4462 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4466 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4467 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4468 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4469 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4470 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4471 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4472 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4475 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4477 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= client_data
;
4478 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4479 int position
= (intptr_t) call_data
;
4483 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4485 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4488 if (eabs (position
) >= height
)
4489 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle
: scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4491 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4492 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4493 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
&& eabs (position
) <= max (5, height
/ 20))
4494 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow
: scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4496 part
= scroll_bar_move_ratio
;
4498 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4499 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4500 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4501 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, position
, height
);
4504 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4506 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4508 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4509 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4513 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4515 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4518 xg_create_scroll_bar (f
, bar
, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback
),
4519 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback
),
4524 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4527 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4533 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4534 unsigned long pixel
;
4539 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4540 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4541 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNminimum
, 0); ++ac
;
4542 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNmaximum
, XM_SB_MAX
); ++ac
;
4543 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNorientation
, XmVERTICAL
); ++ac
;
4544 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNprocessingDirection
, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM
), ++ac
;
4545 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNincrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4546 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNpageIncrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4548 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4551 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNforeground
, pixel
);
4555 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4558 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNbackground
, pixel
);
4562 widget
= XmCreateScrollBar (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
,
4563 (char *) scroll_bar_name
, av
, ac
);
4565 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4566 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4568 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdragCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4570 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNincrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4572 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageDecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4574 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageIncrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4576 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoBottomCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4578 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoTopCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4581 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4582 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
4584 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4585 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4586 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget
), XtWindow (widget
),
4587 f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
);
4589 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4591 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4592 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4593 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4594 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4595 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4596 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNorientation
, XtorientVertical
); ++ac
;
4597 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4598 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4600 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4603 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNforeground
, pixel
);
4607 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4610 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbackground
, pixel
);
4614 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4616 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4617 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4619 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4622 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
4623 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4624 &pixel
, 1.2, 0x8000))
4626 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4629 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4631 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4634 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
4635 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4636 &pixel
, 0.6, 0x4000))
4638 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4642 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4643 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4644 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1
4645 || f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4646 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4647 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4648 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4651 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
,
4652 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
)) < 16);
4656 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4657 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4658 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4660 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4662 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
, False
);
4665 /* Specify the colors. */
4666 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
;
4669 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNtopShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4672 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
;
4675 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbottomShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4681 widget
= XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name
, scrollbarWidgetClass
,
4682 f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
, av
, ac
);
4685 char const *initial
= "";
4686 char const *val
= initial
;
4687 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNscrollVCursor
, (XtPointer
) &val
,
4688 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4689 XtNarrowScrollbars
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll
,
4691 XtNpickTop
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_pick_top
, NULL
);
4692 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
|| val
== initial
)
4693 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4694 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= True
;
4695 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4696 XtVaSetValues (widget
, XtNcursorName
, "top_left_arrow", NULL
);
4700 /* Define callbacks. */
4701 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNjumpProc
, xaw_jump_callback
, (XtPointer
) bar
);
4702 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNscrollProc
, xaw_scroll_callback
,
4705 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4706 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
4708 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4710 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4711 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4712 if (action_hook_id
== 0)
4713 action_hook_id
= XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con
, xt_action_hook
, 0);
4715 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4716 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar
, widget
);
4717 xwindow
= XtWindow (widget
);
4718 bar
->x_window
= xwindow
;
4722 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4725 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4726 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4730 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
, int whole
)
4732 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
4735 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4737 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
,
4740 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
4741 Widget widget
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
4748 if (scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p
)
4750 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4751 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4752 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4753 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4754 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4755 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4756 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4757 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4758 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4759 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4760 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4761 portion
= WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)) * 30;
4762 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4763 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4771 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
4772 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
4775 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
4779 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4780 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4782 size
= clip_to_bounds (1, shown
* XM_SB_MAX
, XM_SB_MAX
);
4784 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4785 value
= top
* XM_SB_MAX
;
4786 value
= min (value
, XM_SB_MAX
- size
);
4788 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget
, value
, size
, 0, 0, False
);
4790 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4796 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
4797 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
4801 float old_top
, old_shown
;
4803 XtVaGetValues (widget
,
4804 XtNtopOfThumb
, &old_top
,
4805 XtNshown
, &old_shown
,
4809 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4810 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
) || last_scroll_bar_part
== scroll_bar_down_arrow
)
4811 top
= max (0, min (1, top
));
4814 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4815 shown
= max (0, min (1 - top
- (2.0f
/ height
), shown
));
4817 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4818 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4819 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4820 if (top
!= old_top
|| shown
!= old_shown
)
4822 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
4823 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
4826 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4827 if (!xaw3d_pick_top
)
4828 shown
= min (shown
, old_shown
);
4830 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
4834 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4838 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4840 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4844 /************************************************************************
4845 Scroll bars, general
4846 ************************************************************************/
4848 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4849 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4850 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4853 static struct scroll_bar
*
4854 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window
*w
, int top
, int left
, int width
, int height
)
4856 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4857 struct scroll_bar
*bar
4858 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar
, x_window
, PVEC_OTHER
);
4863 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4864 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f
, bar
);
4865 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4867 XSetWindowAttributes a
;
4871 a
.background_pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4872 if (a
.background_pixel
== -1)
4873 a
.background_pixel
= FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
);
4875 a
.event_mask
= (ButtonPressMask
| ButtonReleaseMask
4876 | ButtonMotionMask
| PointerMotionHintMask
4878 a
.cursor
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
;
4880 mask
= (CWBackPixel
| CWEventMask
| CWCursor
);
4882 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4883 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4884 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4885 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
4886 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
4887 left
, top
, width
, window_box_height (w
));
4889 window
= XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
4890 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4891 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4893 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4895 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4902 bar
->x_window
= window
;
4904 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4906 XSETWINDOW (bar
->window
, w
);
4910 bar
->height
= height
;
4913 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4914 bar
->fringe_extended_p
= 0;
4916 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4917 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
4919 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
4920 fset_scroll_bars (f
, barobj
);
4921 if (!NILP (bar
->next
))
4922 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
4924 /* Map the window/widget. */
4925 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4928 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
,
4931 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4932 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4934 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4935 Widget scroll_bar
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
4936 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar
,
4937 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4939 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4940 max (height
, 1), 0);
4941 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar
);
4942 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4944 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4945 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
4946 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4953 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4955 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4957 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4958 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4959 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4962 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4963 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4964 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4965 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4966 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4969 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int start
, int end
, int rebuild
)
4971 int dragging
= ! NILP (bar
->dragging
);
4972 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
4973 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
4974 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
4976 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4978 && start
== bar
->start
4985 int inside_width
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f
, bar
->width
);
4986 int inside_height
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f
, bar
->height
);
4987 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
4989 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4990 the distance between start and end. */
4992 int length
= end
- start
;
4996 else if (start
> top_range
)
4998 end
= start
+ length
;
5002 else if (end
> top_range
&& ! dragging
)
5006 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5010 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5011 if (end
> top_range
)
5014 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5015 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5016 that many pixels tall. */
5017 end
+= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
;
5019 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5020 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5022 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5023 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5024 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
,
5025 inside_width
, start
);
5027 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5028 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5029 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5030 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
5032 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5033 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
5034 /* x, y, width, height */
5035 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5036 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ start
,
5037 inside_width
, end
- start
);
5039 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5040 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5041 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5042 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
5044 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5045 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5046 if (end
< inside_height
)
5047 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5048 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5049 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ end
,
5050 inside_width
, inside_height
- end
);
5056 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5058 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5062 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
5064 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5067 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5069 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f
, bar
->x_window
);
5070 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5071 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
));
5072 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5074 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
5077 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5078 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar
->window
), Qnil
);
5084 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5085 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5086 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5090 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window
*w
, int portion
, int whole
, int position
)
5092 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
5094 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5095 int top
, height
, left
, sb_left
, width
, sb_width
;
5096 int window_y
, window_height
;
5097 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5098 bool fringe_extended_p
;
5101 /* Get window dimensions. */
5102 window_box (w
, ANY_AREA
, 0, &window_y
, 0, &window_height
);
5104 width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
5105 height
= window_height
;
5107 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5108 left
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
5110 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5111 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5112 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
) > 0)
5113 sb_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
);
5117 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5118 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5119 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
))
5120 sb_left
= left
+ (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
) ? width
- sb_width
: 0);
5122 sb_left
= left
+ (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
) ? 0 : width
- sb_width
);
5124 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
))
5125 sb_left
= left
+ width
- sb_width
;
5130 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5131 fringe_extended_p
= WINDOW_FRINGE_EXTENDED_P (w
);
5134 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5135 if (NILP (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5137 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5140 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5141 if (fringe_extended_p
)
5142 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5143 sb_left
, top
, sb_width
, height
);
5146 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5147 left
, top
, width
, height
);
5151 bar
= x_scroll_bar_create (w
, top
, sb_left
, sb_width
, height
);
5155 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5156 unsigned int mask
= 0;
5158 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
5162 if (sb_left
!= bar
->left
)
5164 if (top
!= bar
->top
)
5166 if (sb_width
!= bar
->width
)
5168 if (height
!= bar
->height
)
5171 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5173 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5174 if (mask
|| bar
->fringe_extended_p
!= fringe_extended_p
)
5176 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5177 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5178 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5180 if (fringe_extended_p
)
5181 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5182 sb_left
, top
, sb_width
, height
);
5184 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5185 left
, top
, width
, height
);
5188 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
,
5191 sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5192 sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
*2,
5194 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5195 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
),
5196 sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5198 sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
5199 max (height
, 1), 0);
5200 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5202 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5204 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5205 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5206 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
)
5208 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5209 left
, top
, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
, height
);
5210 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5211 left
+ width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5212 top
, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
, height
);
5215 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5216 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5217 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5220 int area_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
5221 int rest
= area_width
- sb_width
;
5222 if (rest
> 0 && height
> 0)
5224 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
5225 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5226 left
+ area_width
- rest
, top
, rest
, height
);
5228 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5229 left
, top
, rest
, height
);
5233 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5238 wc
.x
= sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
5240 wc
.width
= sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2;
5242 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
,
5246 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5248 /* Remember new settings. */
5249 bar
->left
= sb_left
;
5251 bar
->width
= sb_width
;
5252 bar
->height
= height
;
5257 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5258 bar
->fringe_extended_p
= fringe_extended_p
;
5260 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5261 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5262 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5264 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5266 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, height
);
5269 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, 0, top_range
, 0);
5272 int start
= ((double) position
* top_range
) / whole
;
5273 int end
= ((double) (position
+ portion
) * top_range
) / whole
;
5274 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, start
, end
, 0);
5277 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5279 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
5280 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w
, barobj
);
5284 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5285 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5286 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5287 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5288 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5289 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5290 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5292 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5293 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5294 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5297 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (struct frame
*frame
)
5299 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5300 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5303 bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5304 fset_scroll_bars (frame
, XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
);
5305 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5306 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->prev
= Qnil
;
5307 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5308 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
))->prev
= bar
;
5309 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame
, bar
);
5314 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5315 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5318 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window
*window
)
5320 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5324 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5325 if (NILP (window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5328 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (window
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
5330 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5331 f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window
));
5332 if (NILP (bar
->prev
))
5334 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5336 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5337 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5339 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
),
5340 window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5341 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f
, bar
->next
);
5343 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5344 one or the other! */
5348 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->prev
)->next
= bar
->next
;
5350 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
5351 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
= bar
->prev
;
5353 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
5355 XSETVECTOR (barobj
, bar
);
5356 fset_scroll_bars (f
, barobj
);
5357 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
5358 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
5361 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5362 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5365 XTjudge_scroll_bars (struct frame
*f
)
5367 Lisp_Object bar
, next
;
5369 bar
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
5371 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5372 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5373 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f
, Qnil
);
5375 for (; ! NILP (bar
); bar
= next
)
5377 struct scroll_bar
*b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
5379 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
5382 b
->next
= b
->prev
= Qnil
;
5385 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5386 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5390 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5391 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5392 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5394 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5398 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, XEvent
*event
)
5400 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
5401 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5402 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
5403 int width_trim
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
5407 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, bar
->start
, bar
->end
, 1);
5409 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5410 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5411 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5412 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
5414 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5415 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
5417 /* x, y, width, height */
5419 bar
->width
- 1 - width_trim
- width_trim
,
5422 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5423 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5424 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5425 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
5430 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5432 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5433 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5435 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5440 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, XEvent
*event
, struct input_event
*emacs_event
)
5442 if (! WINDOWP (bar
->window
))
5445 emacs_event
->kind
= SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
5446 emacs_event
->code
= event
->xbutton
.button
- Button1
;
5447 emacs_event
->modifiers
5448 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5449 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)))),
5450 event
->xbutton
.state
)
5451 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
5454 emacs_event
->frame_or_window
= bar
->window
;
5455 emacs_event
->arg
= Qnil
;
5456 emacs_event
->timestamp
= event
->xbutton
.time
;
5459 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
5460 int y
= event
->xbutton
.y
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
5463 if (y
> top_range
) y
= top_range
;
5466 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
5467 else if (y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
5468 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5470 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
5472 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5473 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5474 if (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
5475 && ! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5477 int new_start
= y
- XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5478 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
5480 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, 0);
5481 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
5485 XSETINT (emacs_event
->x
, y
);
5486 XSETINT (emacs_event
->y
, top_range
);
5490 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5492 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5494 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5498 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, XMotionEvent
*event
)
5500 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)->frame
);
5502 last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->time
;
5505 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar
, bar
);
5507 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5508 if (! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5510 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5511 int new_start
= event
->y
- XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5513 if (new_start
!= bar
->start
)
5515 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
5517 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, 0);
5522 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5524 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5525 on the scroll bar. */
5528 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**fp
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
,
5529 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
,
5530 Lisp_Object
*y
, Time
*timestamp
)
5532 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar
);
5533 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
5534 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5536 Window dummy_window
;
5538 unsigned int dummy_mask
;
5542 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5544 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5546 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5547 &dummy_window
, &dummy_window
,
5548 &dummy_coord
, &dummy_coord
,
5550 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5553 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5559 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
5561 win_y
-= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
5563 if (! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5564 win_y
-= XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5568 if (win_y
> top_range
)
5572 *bar_window
= bar
->window
;
5574 if (! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5575 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5576 else if (win_y
< bar
->start
)
5577 *part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
5578 else if (win_y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
5579 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5581 *part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
5583 XSETINT (*x
, win_y
);
5584 XSETINT (*y
, top_range
);
5587 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
5590 *timestamp
= last_mouse_movement_time
;
5596 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5597 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5598 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5602 x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame
*f
)
5604 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5607 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5608 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5609 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5610 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f
))
5611 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); VECTORP (bar
);
5612 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
5613 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5614 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
,
5616 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5619 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
5621 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5622 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5624 static int temp_index
;
5625 static short temp_buffer
[100];
5627 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5628 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5630 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5632 #else /* not ENABLE_CHECKING */
5634 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) ((void)0)
5636 #endif /* ENABLE_CHECKING */
5638 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5639 on a particular display. */
5641 static struct x_display_info
*XTread_socket_fake_io_error
;
5643 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5644 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5645 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5646 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5648 static struct x_display_info
*next_noop_dpyinfo
;
5650 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5651 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5654 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5655 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5656 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5657 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5658 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5659 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5671 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5672 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5673 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5675 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5677 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5681 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, XEvent
*event
)
5683 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5684 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5685 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5688 struct frame
*f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5689 event
->xclient
.window
);
5691 return XFilterEvent (event
, f1
? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1
) : None
);
5696 static int current_count
;
5697 static int current_finish
;
5698 static struct input_event
*current_hold_quit
;
5700 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5701 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5702 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5703 static GdkFilterReturn
5704 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent
*gxev
, GdkEvent
*ev
, gpointer data
)
5706 XEvent
*xev
= (XEvent
*) gxev
;
5709 if (current_count
>= 0)
5711 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
5713 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (xev
->xany
.display
);
5716 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5717 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5718 so we do it here. */
5719 if ((xev
->type
== KeyPress
|| xev
->type
== KeyRelease
)
5721 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo
, xev
))
5724 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
5729 current_finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
5732 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, xev
, ¤t_finish
,
5736 current_finish
= x_dispatch_event (xev
, xev
->xany
.display
);
5740 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
|| current_finish
== X_EVENT_DROP
)
5741 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
5743 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE
;
5745 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5748 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame
*f
, Time
,
5749 enum xembed_message
,
5750 long detail
, long data1
, long data2
);
5752 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5754 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5755 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5756 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5758 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5761 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, XEvent
*eventptr
,
5762 int *finish
, struct input_event
*hold_quit
)
5765 struct input_event ie
;
5766 struct selection_input_event sie
;
5770 ptrdiff_t nbytes
= 0;
5771 struct frame
*f
= NULL
;
5772 struct coding_system coding
;
5773 XEvent event
= *eventptr
;
5774 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
5775 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5776 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5777 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5778 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay. */
5779 static XComposeStatus compose_status
;
5783 *finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
5785 EVENT_INIT (inev
.ie
);
5786 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
;
5789 if (pending_event_wait
.eventtype
== event
.type
)
5790 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5796 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5797 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_protocols
5798 && event
.xclient
.format
== 32)
5800 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5801 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_take_focus
)
5803 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5804 could be the shell widget window
5805 if the frame has no title bar. */
5806 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5808 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5809 if (f
&& FRAME_XIC (f
))
5810 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f
));
5812 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5813 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5814 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5815 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5816 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5819 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5820 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5821 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5822 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5825 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5826 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5827 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5830 Display
*d
= event
.xclient
.display
;
5831 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5832 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5834 XSetInputFocus (d
, event
.xclient
.window
,
5835 /* The ICCCM says this is
5836 the only valid choice. */
5838 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1]);
5839 /* This is needed to detect the error
5840 if there is an error. */
5842 x_uncatch_errors ();
5844 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5849 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5850 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
)
5852 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5853 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5854 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5855 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5856 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5857 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5858 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5859 session manager and one for this. */
5861 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5864 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5865 event
.xclient
.window
);
5866 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5867 for a single Emacs process. */
5868 if (f
== SELECTED_FRAME ())
5869 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5870 event
.xclient
.window
,
5871 initial_argv
, initial_argc
);
5873 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5874 event
.xclient
.window
,
5880 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5881 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_delete_window
)
5883 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5884 event
.xclient
.window
);
5886 goto OTHER
; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5888 inev
.ie
.kind
= DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT
;
5889 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
5896 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5897 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
)
5902 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5903 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_window_moved
)
5906 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5908 new_x
= event
.xclient
.data
.s
[0];
5909 new_y
= event
.xclient
.data
.s
[1];
5913 f
->left_pos
= new_x
;
5920 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5921 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_editres
)
5923 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5925 _XEditResCheckMessages (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, NULL
,
5929 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5931 if ((event
.xclient
.message_type
5932 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_DONE
)
5933 || (event
.xclient
.message_type
5934 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_PAGE
))
5936 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5937 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5938 currently never do because we are interested in
5939 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5940 Pixmap pixmap
= (Pixmap
) event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1];
5941 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5944 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap
, f
);
5945 expose_frame (f
, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5949 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5950 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5951 we construct an input_event. */
5952 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5953 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_Scrollbar
)
5955 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event
, &inev
.ie
);
5956 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
5959 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5961 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5962 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5963 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
)
5965 enum xembed_message msg
= event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1];
5966 if (msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_IN
|| msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT
)
5967 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
5969 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
5973 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, &event
);
5975 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5978 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f
, &event
.xclient
, dpyinfo
, &inev
.ie
))
5979 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
5983 case SelectionNotify
:
5984 last_user_time
= event
.xselection
.time
;
5985 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5986 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselection
.requestor
))
5988 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5989 x_handle_selection_notify (&event
.xselection
);
5992 case SelectionClear
: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5993 last_user_time
= event
.xselectionclear
.time
;
5994 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5995 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselectionclear
.window
))
5997 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5999 XSelectionClearEvent
*eventp
= &(event
.xselectionclear
);
6001 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT
;
6002 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->display
;
6003 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
6004 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
6008 case SelectionRequest
: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6009 last_user_time
= event
.xselectionrequest
.time
;
6010 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6011 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselectionrequest
.owner
))
6013 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6015 XSelectionRequestEvent
*eventp
= &(event
.xselectionrequest
);
6017 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT
;
6018 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->display
;
6019 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->requestor
;
6020 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
6021 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->target
;
6022 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->property
;
6023 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
6027 case PropertyNotify
:
6028 last_user_time
= event
.xproperty
.time
;
6029 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xproperty
.window
);
6030 if (f
&& event
.xproperty
.atom
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
)
6031 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f
, &event
.xproperty
)
6032 && FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
6033 && f
->output_data
.x
->net_wm_state_hidden_seen
)
6035 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed.
6036 It hides the frame. So if our state says we aren't
6037 hidden anymore, treat it as deiconified. */
6038 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 1);
6039 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 0);
6040 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
6041 f
->output_data
.x
->net_wm_state_hidden_seen
= 0;
6042 inev
.ie
.kind
= DEICONIFY_EVENT
;
6043 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6046 x_handle_property_notify (&event
.xproperty
);
6047 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, &event
);
6050 case ReparentNotify
:
6051 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xreparent
.window
);
6055 f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
= event
.xreparent
.parent
;
6056 x_real_positions (f
, &x
, &y
);
6060 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6061 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
6062 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->net_supported_window
= 0;
6064 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
6069 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xexpose
.window
);
6073 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6074 x_clear_area (event
.xexpose
.display
,
6075 event
.xexpose
.window
,
6076 event
.xexpose
.x
, event
.xexpose
.y
,
6077 event
.xexpose
.width
, event
.xexpose
.height
);
6079 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
6081 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 1);
6082 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 0);
6083 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
6084 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6088 event
.xexpose
.x
, event
.xexpose
.y
,
6089 event
.xexpose
.width
, event
.xexpose
.height
);
6093 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6094 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
6096 #if defined USE_LUCID
6097 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6098 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6099 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6102 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event
.xexpose
.window
);
6104 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget
);
6106 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6108 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6109 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6111 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6112 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xexpose
.display
,
6113 event
.xexpose
.window
);
6116 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar
, &event
);
6117 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6120 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6121 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6125 case GraphicsExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6126 source area was obscured or not
6128 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xgraphicsexpose
.drawable
);
6132 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.x
, event
.xgraphicsexpose
.y
,
6133 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.width
,
6134 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.height
);
6136 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6139 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6142 case NoExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6143 source area was completely
6148 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6149 if (event
.xunmap
.window
== tip_window
)
6152 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6155 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xunmap
.window
);
6156 if (f
) /* F may no longer exist if
6157 the frame was deleted. */
6159 bool visible
= FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
);
6160 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6161 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6162 display that won't ever be seen. */
6163 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
6164 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6165 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6166 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6167 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6168 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6169 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6170 if (visible
|| FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
6172 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 1);
6173 inev
.ie
.kind
= ICONIFY_EVENT
;
6174 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6180 if (event
.xmap
.window
== tip_window
)
6181 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6182 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6185 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6186 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6187 frame is visible. */
6188 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xmap
.window
);
6191 bool iconified
= FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
);
6192 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6193 the frame's display structures.
6194 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6195 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6196 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6197 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6199 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6201 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6202 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6203 if (!f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
)
6204 x_check_fullscreen (f
);
6206 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 1);
6207 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 0);
6208 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
6212 inev
.ie
.kind
= DEICONIFY_EVENT
;
6213 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6215 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list
) && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
6216 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later to update the
6217 frame titles in case this is the second frame. */
6218 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6221 xg_frame_resized (f
, -1, -1);
6228 last_user_time
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6229 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6231 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6232 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6233 if (popup_activated ())
6237 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xkey
.window
);
6239 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6240 mouse highlighting. */
6241 if (!hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
&& INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight
)
6243 || !EQ (f
->tool_bar_window
, hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
)))
6245 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6246 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 1;
6249 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6252 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6253 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6254 Widget widget
= XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo
->display
,
6256 if (widget
&& XmIsScrollBar (widget
))
6258 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
6259 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, XtWindow (widget
));
6262 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6266 KeySym keysym
, orig_keysym
;
6267 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6268 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6271 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6272 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6273 status_return even if the input is too long to
6274 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6275 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6276 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6277 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6278 unsigned char copy_buffer
[513];
6279 unsigned char *copy_bufptr
= copy_buffer
;
6280 int copy_bufsiz
= sizeof (copy_buffer
);
6282 Lisp_Object coding_system
= Qlatin_1
;
6286 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6287 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6288 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6290 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6294 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
6295 extra_keyboard_modifiers
);
6296 modifiers
= event
.xkey
.state
;
6298 /* This will have to go some day... */
6300 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6301 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6302 event
.xkey
.state
&= ~ControlMask
;
6303 event
.xkey
.state
&= ~(dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
6304 | dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
6305 | dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
6306 | dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
);
6308 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6309 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6310 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6311 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6312 not it is combined with Meta. */
6313 if (modifiers
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
6314 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
6319 Status status_return
;
6321 coding_system
= Vlocale_coding_system
;
6322 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
6323 &event
.xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
6324 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6326 if (status_return
== XBufferOverflow
)
6328 copy_bufsiz
= nbytes
+ 1;
6329 copy_bufptr
= alloca (copy_bufsiz
);
6330 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
6331 &event
.xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
6332 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6335 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6336 if (status_return
== XLookupNone
)
6338 else if (status_return
== XLookupChars
)
6343 else if (status_return
!= XLookupKeySym
6344 && status_return
!= XLookupBoth
)
6348 nbytes
= XLookupString (&event
.xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
6349 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6352 nbytes
= XLookupString (&event
.xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
6353 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6357 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6358 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6359 if (compose_status
.chars_matched
> 0 && nbytes
== 0)
6362 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
6363 orig_keysym
= keysym
;
6365 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6366 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6368 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
), modifiers
);
6369 inev
.ie
.timestamp
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6371 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6372 translations to characters. */
6373 if (keysym
>= 32 && keysym
< 128)
6374 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6376 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6377 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
6381 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6382 if (keysym
>= 0x01000000 && keysym
<= 0x0110FFFF)
6384 if (keysym
< 0x01000080)
6385 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6387 inev
.ie
.kind
= MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6388 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
& 0xFFFFFF;
6392 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6393 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table
)
6394 && (c
= Fgethash (make_number (keysym
),
6399 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c
))
6400 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6401 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
6402 inev
.ie
.code
= XFASTINT (c
);
6406 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6407 if (((keysym
>= XK_BackSpace
&& keysym
<= XK_Escape
)
6408 || keysym
== XK_Delete
6409 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6410 || (keysym
>= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6411 && keysym
<= XK_ISO_Enter
)
6413 || IsCursorKey (keysym
) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6414 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6416 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6417 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6418 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6419 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6420 || (XK_Select
<= keysym
&& keysym
< XK_KP_Space
)
6422 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6423 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_circumflex
6425 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6426 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_grave
6428 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6429 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_tilde
6431 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6432 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_diaeresis
6434 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6435 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_macron
6437 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6438 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_degree
6440 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6441 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_acute
6443 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6444 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_cedilla
6446 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6447 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_breve
6449 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6450 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_ogonek
6452 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6453 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_caron
6455 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6456 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_doubleacute
6458 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6459 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_abovedot
6461 || IsKeypadKey (keysym
) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6462 || IsFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6463 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6464 || (orig_keysym
& (1 << 28))
6465 || (keysym
!= NoSymbol
&& nbytes
== 0))
6466 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym
)
6467 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6468 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6469 don't have real modifiers but
6470 should be treated similarly to
6471 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6472 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6473 || (XK_ISO_Lock
<= orig_keysym
6474 && orig_keysym
<= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
)
6478 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym
);
6479 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6481 inev
.ie
.kind
= NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6482 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
6486 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6490 for (i
= 0, nchars
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
++)
6492 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr
[i
]))
6494 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr
[i
]);
6497 if (nchars
< nbytes
)
6499 /* Decode the input data. */
6501 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6502 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6503 we used just above and the locale. */
6504 setup_coding_system (coding_system
, &coding
);
6505 coding
.src_multibyte
= 0;
6506 coding
.dst_multibyte
= 1;
6507 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6508 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6509 gives us composition information. */
6510 coding
.common_flags
&= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK
;
6512 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding
.destination
, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH
,
6514 coding
.dst_bytes
= MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH
* nbytes
;
6515 coding
.mode
|= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK
;
6516 decode_coding_c_string (&coding
, copy_bufptr
, nbytes
, Qnil
);
6517 nbytes
= coding
.produced
;
6518 nchars
= coding
.produced_char
;
6519 copy_bufptr
= coding
.destination
;
6522 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6523 character events. */
6524 for (i
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
+= len
)
6527 if (nchars
== nbytes
)
6528 ch
= copy_bufptr
[i
], len
= 1;
6530 ch
= STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr
+ i
, len
);
6531 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch
)
6532 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6533 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
6535 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
6540 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
; /* Already stored above. */
6542 if (keysym
== NoSymbol
)
6548 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6549 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6557 last_user_time
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6559 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6560 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6568 last_user_time
= event
.xcrossing
.time
;
6569 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6571 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xcrossing
.window
);
6573 if (f
&& x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
)
6574 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= event
.xmotion
.time
+ 200;
6576 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6577 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6578 if (f
&& !f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_p
)
6579 note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
.xmotion
);
6581 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6582 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6583 if (!f
&& last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
6584 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
.xmotion
);
6589 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6593 last_user_time
= event
.xcrossing
.time
;
6594 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6596 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xcrossing
.window
);
6599 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
6601 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6602 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6603 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6604 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
6607 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6608 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6609 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6610 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6611 if (any_help_event_p
)
6615 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6616 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
6617 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
.xmotion
);
6622 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6627 last_user_time
= event
.xmotion
.time
;
6628 previous_help_echo_string
= help_echo_string
;
6629 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
6631 if (dpyinfo
->grabbed
&& last_mouse_frame
6632 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
6633 f
= last_mouse_frame
;
6635 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xmotion
.window
);
6637 if (hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
)
6639 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 0;
6640 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6644 if (f
&& xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f
, &event
))
6650 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6651 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6652 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window
) && !popup_activated ())
6654 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_window
;
6655 Lisp_Object window
= window_from_coordinates
6656 (f
, event
.xmotion
.x
, event
.xmotion
.y
, 0, 0);
6658 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6659 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6660 will be selected only when it is active. */
6661 if (WINDOWP (window
)
6662 && !EQ (window
, last_mouse_window
)
6663 && !EQ (window
, selected_window
)
6664 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6665 create event iff we don't leave the
6667 && (focus_follows_mouse
6668 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window
)->frame
,
6669 XWINDOW (selected_window
)->frame
))))
6671 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT
;
6672 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= window
;
6674 /* Remember the last window where we saw the mouse. */
6675 last_mouse_window
= window
;
6677 if (!note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
.xmotion
))
6678 help_echo_string
= previous_help_echo_string
;
6682 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6683 struct scroll_bar
*bar
6684 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xmotion
.display
,
6685 event
.xmotion
.window
);
6688 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar
, &event
.xmotion
);
6689 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6691 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6692 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6693 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6696 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6697 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6698 if (!NILP (help_echo_string
)
6699 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string
))
6704 case ConfigureNotify
:
6705 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xconfigure
.window
);
6708 && (f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xconfigure
.window
))
6709 && event
.xconfigure
.window
== FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
6711 xg_frame_resized (f
, event
.xconfigure
.width
,
6712 event
.xconfigure
.height
);
6718 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6720 int rows
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f
, event
.xconfigure
.height
);
6721 int columns
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f
, event
.xconfigure
.width
);
6723 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6724 is called by the code that handles resizing
6725 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6727 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6728 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6729 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6730 if (columns
!= FRAME_COLS (f
)
6731 || rows
!= FRAME_LINES (f
)
6732 || event
.xconfigure
.width
!= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
6733 || event
.xconfigure
.height
!= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
))
6735 change_frame_size (f
, rows
, columns
, 0, 1, 0);
6736 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6737 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
6740 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) = event
.xconfigure
.width
;
6741 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
) = event
.xconfigure
.height
;
6742 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6746 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6747 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6748 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)
6749 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)))
6752 x_real_positions (f
, &f
->left_pos
, &f
->top_pos
);
6756 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
))
6757 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
6766 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6767 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6768 bool tool_bar_p
= 0;
6770 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
6771 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= 0;
6772 last_user_time
= event
.xbutton
.time
;
6774 if (dpyinfo
->grabbed
6776 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
6777 f
= last_mouse_frame
;
6779 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xbutton
.window
);
6782 if (f
&& xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f
, &event
))
6787 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6788 if (WINDOWP (f
->tool_bar_window
)
6789 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f
->tool_bar_window
)))
6792 int x
= event
.xbutton
.x
;
6793 int y
= event
.xbutton
.y
;
6795 window
= window_from_coordinates (f
, x
, y
, 0, 1);
6796 tool_bar_p
= EQ (window
, f
->tool_bar_window
);
6798 if (tool_bar_p
&& event
.xbutton
.button
< 4)
6800 handle_tool_bar_click (f
, x
, y
,
6801 event
.xbutton
.type
== ButtonPress
,
6802 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo
,
6803 event
.xbutton
.state
));
6808 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6809 if (! popup_activated ())
6812 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
)
6814 if (event
.type
== ButtonPress
6815 && (int)(event
.xbutton
.time
- ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
) > 0)
6817 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6818 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
.xbutton
, f
);
6820 if (event
.type
== ButtonRelease
)
6821 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6824 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
.xbutton
, f
);
6826 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
6827 xembed_send_message (f
, event
.xbutton
.time
,
6828 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
, 0, 0, 0);
6832 struct scroll_bar
*bar
6833 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xbutton
.display
,
6834 event
.xbutton
.window
);
6836 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6837 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6839 if (bar
&& event
.xbutton
.state
& ControlMask
)
6841 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6842 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6844 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6846 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6847 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6850 if (event
.type
== ButtonPress
)
6852 dpyinfo
->grabbed
|= (1 << event
.xbutton
.button
);
6853 last_mouse_frame
= f
;
6856 last_tool_bar_item
= -1;
6859 dpyinfo
->grabbed
&= ~(1 << event
.xbutton
.button
);
6861 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6862 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6863 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6867 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6868 f
= x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, &event
);
6869 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6870 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6871 Instead, save it away
6872 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6873 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6874 if (! popup_activated ()
6876 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6877 && event
.xbutton
.button
< 3
6879 && f
&& event
.type
== ButtonPress
6880 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6881 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6882 && event
.xbutton
.x
>= 0
6883 && event
.xbutton
.x
< FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
6884 && event
.xbutton
.y
>= 0
6885 && event
.xbutton
.y
< f
->output_data
.x
->menubar_height
6886 && event
.xbutton
.same_screen
)
6888 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT
;
6889 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6893 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6897 case CirculateNotify
:
6900 case CirculateRequest
:
6903 case VisibilityNotify
:
6907 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6909 switch (event
.xmapping
.request
)
6911 case MappingModifier
:
6912 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
6913 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6914 case MappingKeyboard
:
6915 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event
.xmapping
);
6920 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, &event
);
6925 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6927 if (*finish
!= X_EVENT_DROP
)
6928 XtDispatchEvent (&event
);
6930 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6935 if (inev
.ie
.kind
!= NO_EVENT
)
6937 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
6942 && !(hold_quit
&& hold_quit
->kind
!= NO_EVENT
))
6947 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
6953 any_help_event_p
= 1;
6954 gen_help_event (help_echo_string
, frame
, help_echo_window
,
6955 help_echo_object
, help_echo_pos
);
6959 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
6960 gen_help_event (Qnil
, frame
, Qnil
, Qnil
, 0);
6970 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
6972 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6973 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6974 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6976 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6978 x_dispatch_event (XEvent
*event
, Display
*display
)
6980 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
6981 int finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
6983 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (display
);
6986 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, event
, &finish
, 0);
6993 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6994 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6996 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6997 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
6998 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7002 XTread_socket (struct terminal
*terminal
, struct input_event
*hold_quit
)
7005 int event_found
= 0;
7009 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7010 input_signal_count
++;
7012 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7013 if (terminal
->display_info
.x
== XTread_socket_fake_io_error
)
7015 XTread_socket_fake_io_error
= 0;
7016 x_io_error_quitter (terminal
->display_info
.x
->display
);
7020 while (XPending (terminal
->display_info
.x
->display
))
7025 XNextEvent (terminal
->display_info
.x
->display
, &event
);
7028 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7029 if (x_filter_event (terminal
->display_info
.x
, &event
))
7034 count
+= handle_one_xevent (terminal
->display_info
.x
,
7035 &event
, &finish
, hold_quit
);
7037 if (finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7045 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7046 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7047 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7048 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7050 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7051 from all displays. */
7053 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7055 current_count
= count
;
7056 current_hold_quit
= hold_quit
;
7058 gtk_main_iteration ();
7060 count
= current_count
;
7062 current_hold_quit
= 0;
7064 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7067 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7069 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7070 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7073 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7074 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7075 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7077 if (x_noop_count
>= 100)
7081 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== 0)
7082 next_noop_dpyinfo
= x_display_list
;
7084 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo
->display
);
7086 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7087 next_noop_dpyinfo
= next_noop_dpyinfo
->next
;
7091 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7093 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7094 if (pending_autoraise_frame
)
7096 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame
);
7097 pending_autoraise_frame
= 0;
7108 /***********************************************************************
7110 ***********************************************************************/
7112 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7113 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7115 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7116 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7117 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7120 x_clip_to_row (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
,
7121 enum glyph_row_area area
, GC gc
)
7123 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7124 XRectangle clip_rect
;
7125 int window_x
, window_y
, window_width
;
7127 window_box (w
, area
, &window_x
, &window_y
, &window_width
, 0);
7129 clip_rect
.x
= window_x
;
7130 clip_rect
.y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, row
->y
));
7131 clip_rect
.y
= max (clip_rect
.y
, window_y
);
7132 clip_rect
.width
= window_width
;
7133 clip_rect
.height
= row
->visible_height
;
7135 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
, 0, 0, &clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
7139 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7142 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
)
7144 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7145 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
7146 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
7149 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
7152 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7153 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7154 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
7155 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
7158 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7159 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w
, row
, cursor_glyph
, &x
, &y
, &h
);
7160 wd
= w
->phys_cursor_width
;
7162 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7163 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7164 xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
7165 if (dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
)
7166 XChangeGC (dpy
, dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7168 dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
7169 GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7170 gc
= dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
;
7172 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7173 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
7174 XDrawRectangle (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
, x
, y
, wd
, h
- 1);
7175 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
7179 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7181 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7182 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7183 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7187 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, int width
, enum text_cursor_kinds kind
)
7189 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
7190 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
7192 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7193 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7195 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
7196 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
7199 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7200 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7201 the bar might not be in the window. */
7202 if (cursor_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
)
7204 struct glyph_row
*r
;
7205 r
= MATRIX_ROW (w
->current_matrix
, w
->phys_cursor
.vpos
);
7206 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, r
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
7210 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
7211 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
7212 GC gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
7213 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
7214 struct face
*face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, cursor_glyph
->face_id
);
7217 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7218 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7219 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7220 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7221 that the glyph is legible. */
7222 if (face
->background
== f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
7223 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= face
->foreground
;
7225 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
7226 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= 0;
7229 XChangeGC (dpy
, gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
7232 gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
7233 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
= gc
;
7236 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
7238 if (kind
== BAR_CURSOR
)
7240 int x
= WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
);
7243 width
= FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f
);
7244 width
= min (cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
, width
);
7246 w
->phys_cursor_width
= width
;
7248 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7249 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7250 if ((cursor_glyph
->resolved_level
& 1) != 0)
7251 x
+= cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
- width
;
7253 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
, x
,
7254 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
),
7255 width
, row
->height
);
7259 int dummy_x
, dummy_y
, dummy_h
;
7262 width
= row
->height
;
7264 width
= min (row
->height
, width
);
7266 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w
, row
, cursor_glyph
, &dummy_x
,
7267 &dummy_y
, &dummy_h
);
7269 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
,
7270 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
),
7271 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
+
7272 row
->height
- width
),
7273 w
->phys_cursor_width
, width
);
7276 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
7281 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7284 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame
*f
, Cursor cursor
)
7286 if (!f
->pointer_invisible
7287 && f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
!= cursor
)
7288 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), cursor
);
7289 f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
= cursor
;
7293 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7296 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
)
7298 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), x
, y
, width
, height
);
7300 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7301 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
7302 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
7307 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7310 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*glyph_row
, int x
,
7311 int y
, enum text_cursor_kinds cursor_type
,
7312 int cursor_width
, bool on_p
, bool active_p
)
7314 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7318 w
->phys_cursor_type
= cursor_type
;
7319 w
->phys_cursor_on_p
= 1;
7321 if (glyph_row
->exact_window_width_line_p
7322 && (glyph_row
->reversed_p
7323 ? (w
->phys_cursor
.hpos
< 0)
7324 : (w
->phys_cursor
.hpos
>= glyph_row
->used
[TEXT_AREA
])))
7326 glyph_row
->cursor_in_fringe_p
= 1;
7327 draw_fringe_bitmap (w
, glyph_row
, glyph_row
->reversed_p
);
7331 switch (cursor_type
)
7333 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR
:
7334 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w
, glyph_row
);
7337 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR
:
7338 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, glyph_row
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
7342 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, BAR_CURSOR
);
7346 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, HBAR_CURSOR
);
7350 w
->phys_cursor_width
= 0;
7359 if (w
== XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
))
7360 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
))
7361 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, x
, y
);
7366 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
7373 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7376 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object file
)
7378 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id
;
7380 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
7383 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7384 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
7385 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
7386 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
7391 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7392 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7393 if (xg_set_icon (f
, file
))
7395 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7396 bitmap_id
= x_create_bitmap_from_file (f
, file
);
7397 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, bitmap_id
);
7401 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7402 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
< 0)
7408 if (xg_set_icon (f
, xg_default_icon_file
)
7409 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
))
7412 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7414 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
);
7416 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
7420 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7423 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_data (f
, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits
,
7424 gnu_xbm_width
, gnu_xbm_height
);
7428 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
7429 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
7433 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7434 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7435 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7436 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7437 x_reference_bitmap (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
7439 bitmap_id
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
;
7442 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, bitmap_id
);
7443 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= bitmap_id
;
7449 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7450 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7453 x_text_icon (struct frame
*f
, const char *icon_name
)
7455 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
7460 text
.value
= (unsigned char *) icon_name
;
7461 text
.encoding
= XA_STRING
;
7463 text
.nitems
= strlen (icon_name
);
7464 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
), &text
);
7467 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
7468 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
7469 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
7470 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, 0);
7475 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7477 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7478 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7480 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7481 be called from a signal handler.
7484 struct x_error_message_stack
{
7485 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
7487 struct x_error_message_stack
*prev
;
7489 static struct x_error_message_stack
*x_error_message
;
7491 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7492 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7493 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7496 x_error_catcher (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
7498 XGetErrorText (display
, event
->error_code
,
7499 x_error_message
->string
,
7500 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
7503 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7504 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7507 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7508 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7509 stored in *x_error_message.
7511 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7512 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7514 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7517 x_catch_errors (Display
*dpy
)
7519 struct x_error_message_stack
*data
= xmalloc (sizeof *data
);
7521 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7525 data
->string
[0] = 0;
7526 data
->prev
= x_error_message
;
7527 x_error_message
= data
;
7530 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7531 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7534 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7536 struct x_error_message_stack
*tmp
;
7540 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7541 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7542 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message
->dpy
) != 0)
7543 XSync (x_error_message
->dpy
, False
);
7545 tmp
= x_error_message
;
7546 x_error_message
= x_error_message
->prev
;
7551 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7552 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7553 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7556 x_check_errors (Display
*dpy
, const char *format
)
7558 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7561 if (x_error_message
->string
[0])
7563 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
7564 memcpy (string
, x_error_message
->string
, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
7565 x_uncatch_errors ();
7566 error (format
, string
);
7570 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7571 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7574 x_had_errors_p (Display
*dpy
)
7576 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7579 return x_error_message
->string
[0] != 0;
7582 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7585 x_clear_errors (Display
*dpy
)
7587 x_error_message
->string
[0] = 0;
7590 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7591 * idea. --lorentey */
7592 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7595 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7597 while (x_error_message
)
7598 x_uncatch_errors ();
7603 static unsigned int x_wire_count
;
7606 fprintf (stderr
, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count
);
7611 /************************************************************************
7613 ************************************************************************/
7615 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7617 static char *error_msg
;
7619 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7620 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7623 x_connection_closed (Display
*dpy
, const char *error_message
)
7625 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
7626 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
7627 ptrdiff_t idx
= SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7629 error_msg
= alloca (strlen (error_message
) + 1);
7630 strcpy (error_msg
, error_message
);
7632 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7633 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay
, Qt
);
7637 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7639 dpyinfo
->reference_count
++;
7640 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
++;
7643 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7644 that are on the dead display. */
7645 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7647 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame
;
7649 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame
))));
7650 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
7651 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
))
7652 && ! EQ (frame
, minibuf_frame
)
7653 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
7654 delete_frame (frame
, Qnoelisp
);
7657 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7658 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7659 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7660 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7661 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
7662 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
7664 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7665 trying to find a replacement. */
7666 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame
)), Qt
);
7667 delete_frame (frame
, Qnoelisp
);
7670 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7671 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7674 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7675 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7676 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7678 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7679 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7680 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7681 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7682 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil
);
7683 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n\
7684 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7685 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7686 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7689 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7691 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7692 dpyinfo
->display
= 0;
7694 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
7695 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
--;
7696 if (dpyinfo
->reference_count
!= 0)
7697 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7702 XSETTERMINAL (tmp
, dpyinfo
->terminal
);
7703 Fdelete_terminal (tmp
, Qnoelisp
);
7707 if (terminal_list
== 0)
7709 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n", error_msg
);
7710 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7714 totally_unblock_input ();
7716 unbind_to (idx
, Qnil
);
7717 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7719 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7720 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list
) return; )
7722 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7723 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7724 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7725 error ("%s", error_msg
);
7728 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7729 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7730 static void x_error_quitter (Display
*, XErrorEvent
*);
7732 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7733 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7736 x_error_handler (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
7738 #if defined USE_GTK && defined HAVE_GTK3
7739 if ((event
->error_code
== BadMatch
|| event
->error_code
== BadWindow
)
7740 && event
->request_code
== X_SetInputFocus
)
7746 if (x_error_message
)
7747 x_error_catcher (display
, event
);
7749 x_error_quitter (display
, event
);
7753 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7754 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7755 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7757 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7759 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7760 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7762 static void NO_INLINE
7763 x_error_quitter (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
7765 char buf
[256], buf1
[356];
7767 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7768 or colors that are not defined. */
7770 if (event
->error_code
== BadName
)
7773 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7774 original error handler. */
7776 XGetErrorText (display
, event
->error_code
, buf
, sizeof (buf
));
7777 sprintf (buf1
, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7778 buf
, event
->request_code
);
7779 x_connection_closed (display
, buf1
);
7783 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7784 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7785 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7788 x_io_error_quitter (Display
*display
)
7792 snprintf (buf
, sizeof buf
, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7793 DisplayString (display
));
7794 x_connection_closed (display
, buf
);
7798 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7800 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7801 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7802 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7806 x_new_font (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object font_object
, int fontset
)
7808 struct font
*font
= XFONT_OBJECT (font_object
);
7811 fontset
= fontset_from_font (font_object
);
7812 FRAME_FONTSET (f
) = fontset
;
7813 if (FRAME_FONT (f
) == font
)
7814 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7818 FRAME_FONT (f
) = font
;
7819 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f
) = font
->baseline_offset
;
7820 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
) = font
->average_width
;
7821 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
) = FONT_HEIGHT (font
);
7823 compute_fringe_widths (f
, 1);
7825 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7826 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) > 0)
7828 int wid
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
7829 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
)
7830 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) + wid
-1) / wid
;
7834 int wid
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
7835 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) = (14 + wid
- 1) / wid
;
7838 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) != 0)
7840 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7841 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7842 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7843 if (NILP (tip_frame
) || XFRAME (tip_frame
) != f
)
7844 x_set_window_size (f
, 0, FRAME_COLS (f
), FRAME_LINES (f
));
7849 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & (XIMPreeditPosition
| XIMStatusArea
)))
7852 xic_set_xfontset (f
, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset
)));
7861 /***********************************************************************
7863 ***********************************************************************/
7869 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7870 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7871 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7874 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim
, XPointer client_data
, XPointer call_data
)
7876 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= (struct x_display_info
*) client_data
;
7877 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
7881 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7882 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7884 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
7885 if (FRAME_X_P (f
) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
)
7887 FRAME_XIC (f
) = NULL
;
7888 xic_free_xfontset (f
);
7892 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7893 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
7894 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
7898 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7901 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7902 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM
, ...);
7905 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7906 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7909 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, char *resource_name
)
7917 XCloseIM (dpyinfo
->xim
);
7918 xim
= XOpenIM (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
, resource_name
,
7925 XIMCallback destroy
;
7928 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7929 XGetIMValues (xim
, XNQueryInputStyle
, &dpyinfo
->xim_styles
, NULL
);
7932 destroy
.callback
= xim_destroy_callback
;
7933 destroy
.client_data
= (XPointer
)dpyinfo
;
7934 XSetIMValues (xim
, XNDestroyCallback
, &destroy
, NULL
);
7940 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
7941 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
7945 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
7947 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
7948 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
7949 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
7950 when the callback was registered. */
7953 xim_instantiate_callback (Display
*display
, XPointer client_data
, XPointer call_data
)
7955 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
= (struct xim_inst_t
*) client_data
;
7956 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= xim_inst
->dpyinfo
;
7958 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
7962 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, xim_inst
->resource_name
);
7964 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
7965 as they have no XIC. */
7966 if (dpyinfo
->xim
&& dpyinfo
->reference_count
> 0)
7968 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
7971 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7973 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
7976 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == xim_inst
->dpyinfo
)
7977 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) == NULL
)
7979 create_frame_xic (f
);
7980 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
)
7981 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
7982 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
)
7984 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
);
7985 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, w
->cursor
.x
, w
->cursor
.y
);
7994 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
7997 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7998 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
7999 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8000 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8003 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, char *resource_name
)
8005 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8009 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8010 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
= xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst
);
8012 dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
= xim_inst
;
8013 xim_inst
->dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
;
8014 xim_inst
->resource_name
= xstrdup (resource_name
);
8015 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
,
8016 resource_name
, emacs_class
,
8017 xim_instantiate_callback
,
8018 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8019 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8020 least, hence the configure test. */
8021 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6
) xim_inst
);
8022 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8023 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
8024 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8026 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8030 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8033 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
8038 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8039 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8040 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
,
8042 xim_instantiate_callback
, NULL
);
8043 xfree (dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
->resource_name
);
8044 xfree (dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
);
8045 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8046 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8047 XCloseIM (dpyinfo
->xim
);
8048 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8049 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
8051 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8054 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8058 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8059 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8062 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame
*f
)
8064 int flags
= f
->size_hint_flags
;
8066 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8067 is already for the top-left corner. */
8068 if (! ((flags
& XNegative
) || (flags
& YNegative
)))
8071 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8072 position that fits on the screen. */
8073 if (flags
& XNegative
)
8074 f
->left_pos
= x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
8075 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) + f
->left_pos
;
8078 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8080 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8081 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8082 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8084 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8085 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8086 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8087 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8090 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8091 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8093 XtVaGetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->column_widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
8096 if (flags
& YNegative
)
8097 f
->top_pos
= x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
8098 - height
+ f
->top_pos
;
8101 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8102 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8103 so the flags should correspond. */
8104 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8107 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8108 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8109 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8110 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8111 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8114 x_set_offset (struct frame
*f
, register int xoff
, register int yoff
, int change_gravity
)
8116 int modified_top
, modified_left
;
8118 if (change_gravity
> 0)
8120 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->left_before_move
= f
->left_pos
;
8121 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->top_before_move
= f
->top_pos
;
8125 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8127 f
->size_hint_flags
|= XNegative
;
8129 f
->size_hint_flags
|= YNegative
;
8130 f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
8132 x_calc_absolute_position (f
);
8135 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 0);
8137 modified_left
= f
->left_pos
;
8138 modified_top
= f
->top_pos
;
8140 if (change_gravity
!= 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
)
8142 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8143 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8144 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8145 modified_left
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
8146 modified_top
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
8149 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8150 modified_left
, modified_top
);
8152 x_sync_with_move (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
,
8153 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8156 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8157 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8158 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8159 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8162 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8163 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8164 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8166 if (change_gravity
!= 0 &&
8167 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8168 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
8169 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
== 0
8170 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
== 0))))
8171 x_check_expected_move (f
, modified_left
, modified_top
);
8176 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8177 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8178 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8179 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8180 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8183 wm_supports (struct frame
*f
, Atom want_atom
)
8186 unsigned long actual_size
, bytes_remaining
;
8187 int i
, rc
, actual_format
;
8188 Window wmcheck_window
;
8189 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8190 Window target_window
= dpyinfo
->root_window
;
8191 long max_len
= 65536;
8192 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
8193 unsigned char *tmp_data
= NULL
;
8194 Atom target_type
= XA_WINDOW
;
8198 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
8199 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
8200 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check
,
8201 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
8202 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
8203 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
8205 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_WINDOW
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8207 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8208 x_uncatch_errors ();
8213 wmcheck_window
= *(Window
*) tmp_data
;
8216 /* Check if window exists. */
8217 XSelectInput (dpy
, wmcheck_window
, StructureNotifyMask
);
8219 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8221 x_uncatch_errors ();
8226 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
!= wmcheck_window
)
8228 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8229 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
!= NULL
)
8230 XFree (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
);
8231 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= NULL
;
8232 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= 0;
8233 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= 0;
8235 target_type
= XA_ATOM
;
8237 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
8238 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supported
,
8239 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
8240 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
8241 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
8243 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_ATOM
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8245 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8246 x_uncatch_errors ();
8251 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= (Atom
*)tmp_data
;
8252 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= actual_size
;
8253 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= wmcheck_window
;
8258 for (i
= 0; rc
== 0 && i
< dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
; ++i
)
8259 rc
= dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
[i
] == want_atom
;
8261 x_uncatch_errors ();
8268 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame
, int add
, Atom atom
, Atom value
)
8270 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame
));
8272 x_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
8273 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
,
8275 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8277 (make_number (add
? 1 : 0),
8279 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom
),
8281 ? list1 (make_fixnum_or_float (value
))
8286 x_set_sticky (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object new_value
, Lisp_Object old_value
)
8289 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8291 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
8293 set_wm_state (frame
, NILP (new_value
) ? 0 : 1,
8294 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
, None
);
8297 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8298 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8299 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8301 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8304 get_current_wm_state (struct frame
*f
,
8310 unsigned long actual_size
, bytes_remaining
;
8311 int i
, rc
, actual_format
, is_hidden
= 0;
8312 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8313 long max_len
= 65536;
8314 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
8315 unsigned char *tmp_data
= NULL
;
8316 Atom target_type
= XA_ATOM
;
8319 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
8322 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
8323 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, window
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
,
8324 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
8325 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
8326 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
8328 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= target_type
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8330 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8331 x_uncatch_errors ();
8333 return !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
);
8336 x_uncatch_errors ();
8338 for (i
= 0; i
< actual_size
; ++i
)
8340 Atom a
= ((Atom
*)tmp_data
)[i
];
8341 if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden
)
8344 f
->output_data
.x
->net_wm_state_hidden_seen
= 1;
8346 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
)
8348 if (*size_state
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
)
8349 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
;
8351 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
;
8353 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
)
8355 if (*size_state
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
)
8356 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
;
8358 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
;
8360 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
)
8361 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_BOTH
;
8362 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
)
8366 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8371 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8374 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame
*f
)
8376 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8377 int have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
);
8380 (void)get_current_wm_state (f
, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
), &cur
, &dummy
);
8382 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8383 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8385 have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
);
8387 if (have_net_atom
&& cur
!= f
->want_fullscreen
)
8391 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
8393 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8394 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8395 are sent at once. */
8396 switch (f
->want_fullscreen
)
8398 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
8399 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8400 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
)
8401 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
8402 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8403 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
8405 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
8406 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8407 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8408 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
8409 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8410 if (cur
!= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8411 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
, None
);
8413 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
8414 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8415 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8416 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
8417 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
);
8418 if (cur
!= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8419 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
, None
);
8421 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
8422 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
8423 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
8424 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
8425 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8427 case FULLSCREEN_NONE
:
8428 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
8429 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
8431 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
8432 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8435 f
->want_fullscreen
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
8439 return have_net_atom
;
8443 XTfullscreen_hook (struct frame
*f
)
8445 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
8448 x_check_fullscreen (f
);
8456 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame
*f
, XPropertyEvent
*event
)
8458 int value
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
8461 int not_hidden
= get_current_wm_state (f
, event
->window
, &value
, &sticky
);
8466 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
8469 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
8472 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
8475 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
8480 store_frame_param (f
, Qfullscreen
, lval
);
8481 store_frame_param (f
, Qsticky
, sticky
? Qt
: Qnil
);
8486 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8487 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8489 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame
*f
)
8491 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f
))
8494 if (f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
!= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
)
8495 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8497 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8498 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8499 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8501 if (f
->want_fullscreen
!= FULLSCREEN_NONE
)
8503 int width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
), height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8504 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8506 switch (f
->want_fullscreen
)
8508 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8509 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
8510 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
8511 width
= x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo
);
8512 height
= x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo
);
8514 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
8515 width
= x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo
);
8517 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
8518 height
= x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo
);
8521 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8526 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8527 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8528 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8529 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8530 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8531 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8532 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8535 x_check_expected_move (struct frame
*f
, int expected_left
, int expected_top
)
8537 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
8539 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8540 window manager window around the frame. */
8542 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
8544 if (current_left
!= expected_left
|| current_top
!= expected_top
)
8546 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8551 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_A
;
8552 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
= expected_left
- current_left
;
8553 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
= expected_top
- current_top
;
8555 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8557 adjusted_left
= expected_left
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
8558 adjusted_top
= expected_top
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
8560 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8561 adjusted_left
, adjusted_top
);
8563 x_sync_with_move (f
, expected_left
, expected_top
, 0);
8566 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8567 frame's position. */
8569 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_B
;
8573 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8574 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8575 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8576 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8577 of an exact comparison. */
8580 x_sync_with_move (struct frame
*f
, int left
, int top
, int fuzzy
)
8584 while (count
++ < 50)
8586 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
8588 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8589 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8592 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
8593 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
8597 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8600 if (eabs (current_left
- left
) <= 10
8601 && eabs (current_top
- top
) <= 40)
8604 else if (current_left
== left
&& current_top
== top
)
8608 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8609 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8611 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil
, NULL
, 0);
8615 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8617 x_wait_for_event (struct frame
*f
, int eventtype
)
8619 int level
= interrupt_input_blocked
;
8622 struct timespec tmo
, tmo_at
, time_now
;
8623 int fd
= ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8625 pending_event_wait
.f
= f
;
8626 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= eventtype
;
8628 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8629 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8630 tmo
= make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8631 tmo_at
= timespec_add (current_timespec (), tmo
);
8633 while (pending_event_wait
.eventtype
)
8635 pending_signals
= 1;
8636 totally_unblock_input ();
8637 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8639 interrupt_input_blocked
= level
;
8644 time_now
= current_timespec ();
8645 if (timespec_cmp (tmo_at
, time_now
) < 0)
8648 tmo
= timespec_sub (tmo_at
, time_now
);
8649 if (pselect (fd
+ 1, &fds
, NULL
, NULL
, &tmo
, NULL
) == 0)
8650 break; /* Timeout */
8652 pending_event_wait
.f
= 0;
8653 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= 0;
8657 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8658 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8659 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8660 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8663 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame
*f
, int change_gravity
, int cols
, int rows
)
8665 int pixelwidth
, pixelheight
;
8667 check_frame_size (f
, &rows
, &cols
);
8668 f
->scroll_bar_actual_width
8669 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f
)
8671 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
));
8673 compute_fringe_widths (f
, 0);
8675 pixelwidth
= FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, cols
)
8676 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f
);
8677 pixelheight
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, rows
)
8678 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
8680 if (change_gravity
) f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
8681 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 0);
8682 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8683 pixelwidth
, pixelheight
);
8686 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8687 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8688 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8689 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8690 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
8692 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8693 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8694 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8695 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8697 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8698 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8699 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8700 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8701 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8703 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8706 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8707 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8708 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8709 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
8710 x_wait_for_event (f
, ConfigureNotify
);
8713 change_frame_size (f
, rows
, cols
, 0, 1, 0);
8714 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) = pixelwidth
;
8715 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
) = pixelheight
;
8721 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8722 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8723 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8724 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8727 x_set_window_size (struct frame
*f
, int change_gravity
, int cols
, int rows
)
8731 if (NILP (tip_frame
) || XFRAME (tip_frame
) != f
)
8735 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8736 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8737 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8738 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8739 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8740 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8741 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8742 int pixelh
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8743 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8744 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8746 pixelh
-= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
8748 r
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f
, pixelh
);
8749 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8750 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8751 f
->scroll_bar_actual_width
8752 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
8753 c
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f
, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
));
8754 change_frame_size (f
, r
, c
, 0, 1, 0);
8758 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
8759 xg_frame_set_char_size (f
, cols
, rows
);
8761 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, cols
, rows
);
8762 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8764 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, cols
, rows
);
8766 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8768 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8769 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f
->root_window
));
8771 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8772 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8773 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8774 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8775 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
8780 /* Mouse warping. */
8783 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
)
8787 pix_x
= FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f
, x
) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
) / 2;
8788 pix_y
= FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f
, y
) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
) / 2;
8790 if (pix_x
< 0) pix_x
= 0;
8791 if (pix_x
> FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)) pix_x
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
8793 if (pix_y
< 0) pix_y
= 0;
8794 if (pix_y
> FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
)) pix_y
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8798 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
8799 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x
, pix_y
);
8803 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8806 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame
*f
, int pix_x
, int pix_y
)
8810 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
8811 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x
, pix_y
);
8815 /* Raise frame F. */
8818 x_raise_frame (struct frame
*f
)
8821 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
8822 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
8823 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8827 /* Lower frame F. */
8830 x_lower_frame (struct frame
*f
)
8832 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
8835 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
8836 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8841 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8844 xembed_request_focus (struct frame
*f
)
8846 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8847 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8848 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
8849 xembed_send_message (f
, CurrentTime
,
8850 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
, 0, 0, 0);
8853 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8856 x_ewmh_activate_frame (struct frame
*f
)
8858 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8859 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8861 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8863 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) && wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
))
8866 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
8867 x_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
8868 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
,
8869 make_number (32), list2i (1, last_user_time
));
8874 XTframe_raise_lower (struct frame
*f
, int raise_flag
)
8882 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8884 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8886 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8888 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8891 xembed_set_info (struct frame
*f
, enum xembed_info flags
)
8893 unsigned long data
[2];
8894 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8896 data
[0] = XEMBED_VERSION
;
8899 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8900 dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
,
8901 32, PropModeReplace
, (unsigned char *) data
, 2);
8903 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
8906 xembed_send_message (struct frame
*f
, Time t
, enum xembed_message msg
,
8907 long int detail
, long int data1
, long int data2
)
8911 event
.xclient
.type
= ClientMessage
;
8912 event
.xclient
.window
= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
;
8913 event
.xclient
.message_type
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_XEMBED
;
8914 event
.xclient
.format
= 32;
8915 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0] = t
;
8916 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1] = msg
;
8917 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[2] = detail
;
8918 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[3] = data1
;
8919 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[4] = data2
;
8921 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
,
8922 False
, NoEventMask
, &event
);
8923 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
8926 /* Change of visibility. */
8928 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8929 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8930 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8931 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8932 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8933 finishes with it. */
8936 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame
*f
)
8939 int original_top
, original_left
;
8940 int retry_count
= 2;
8946 type
= x_icon_type (f
);
8948 x_bitmap_icon (f
, type
);
8950 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
8952 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8953 call x_set_offset a second time
8954 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8955 before the window gets really visible. */
8956 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
8957 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
)
8958 && ! f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
)
8959 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
8961 f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
= 1;
8963 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
8964 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, NormalState
);
8965 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8966 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
8967 xembed_set_info (f
, XEMBED_MAPPED
);
8970 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8971 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
8973 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8975 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
8976 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
8978 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
8979 xembed_set_info (f
, XEMBED_MAPPED
);
8981 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
8982 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8983 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8986 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8988 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8989 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8990 so that incoming events are handled. */
8994 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8995 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8996 will set it when they are handled. */
8997 int previously_visible
= f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
;
8999 original_left
= f
->left_pos
;
9000 original_top
= f
->top_pos
;
9002 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9005 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9007 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9008 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9009 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9010 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9012 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9013 because the window manager may choose the position
9014 and we don't want to override it. */
9016 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
)
9017 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9018 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
)
9019 && f
->win_gravity
== NorthWestGravity
9020 && previously_visible
)
9024 unsigned int width
, height
, border
, depth
;
9028 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9029 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9030 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9031 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9032 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9033 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9034 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9035 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9036 &rootw
, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
, &border
, &depth
);
9038 if (original_left
!= x
|| original_top
!= y
)
9039 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9040 original_left
, original_top
);
9045 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9047 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9048 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9049 MapNotify at all.. */
9050 for (count
= input_signal_count
+ 10;
9051 input_signal_count
< count
&& !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
);)
9053 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9056 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9057 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9058 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9059 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9060 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9062 if (input_polling_used ())
9064 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9065 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9066 handler reset it. */
9067 int old_poll_suppress_count
= poll_suppress_count
;
9068 poll_suppress_count
= 1;
9069 poll_for_input_1 ();
9070 poll_suppress_count
= old_poll_suppress_count
;
9076 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9080 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9081 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9082 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9083 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9085 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) && --retry_count
!= 0)
9090 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9092 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9095 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame
*f
)
9099 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9100 window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9102 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9103 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9104 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9108 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9109 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9110 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9111 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9112 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9113 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 1);
9116 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9117 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9120 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9121 xembed_set_info (f
, 0);
9126 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
,
9127 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))))
9130 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9134 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9135 just by the event that we get from the server.
9136 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9137 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9138 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9139 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
9140 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 0);
9147 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9150 x_iconify_frame (struct frame
*f
)
9152 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9157 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9158 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9159 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9161 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
9166 type
= x_icon_type (f
);
9168 x_bitmap_icon (f
, type
);
9170 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9171 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9173 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9174 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9176 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
9177 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
9178 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 1);
9184 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9186 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9188 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
9189 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
9190 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9191 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9192 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9193 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9194 so we have to record it here. */
9195 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
9196 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 1);
9201 result
= XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
9202 XtWindow (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
),
9203 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)));
9207 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9209 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 1);
9210 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
9213 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9215 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9217 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9218 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9219 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
)
9220 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9221 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9222 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
9224 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9225 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9227 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9228 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9232 msg
.xclient
.window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
9233 msg
.xclient
.type
= ClientMessage
;
9234 msg
.xclient
.message_type
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_wm_change_state
;
9235 msg
.xclient
.format
= 32;
9236 msg
.xclient
.data
.l
[0] = IconicState
;
9238 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
9239 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)),
9241 SubstructureRedirectMask
| SubstructureNotifyMask
,
9245 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9249 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9251 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
9253 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9255 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9256 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9259 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f
, 1);
9260 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f
, 0);
9262 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9264 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9268 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9271 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame
*f
)
9273 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9274 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
9275 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9277 struct scroll_bar
*b
;
9282 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9283 commands to the X server. */
9284 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
9286 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9287 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9289 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f
))
9290 free_frame_faces (f
);
9292 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
)
9293 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
);
9295 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9296 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9297 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9298 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9299 toolkit scroll bars. */
9300 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); !NILP (bar
); bar
= b
->next
)
9302 b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
9303 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
9312 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9313 if (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
)
9315 XtDestroyWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9316 f
->output_data
.x
->widget
= NULL
;
9318 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9319 we are using a toolkit. */
9320 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
9321 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9323 free_frame_menubar (f
);
9324 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9327 xg_free_frame_widgets (f
);
9328 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9330 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
9331 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9332 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9334 unload_color (f
, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
9335 unload_color (f
, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
9336 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
);
9337 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
);
9338 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
9339 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->mouse_pixel
);
9341 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
!= -1)
9342 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
);
9343 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
9344 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
9345 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9346 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9347 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
9348 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
);
9349 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
9350 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
);
9351 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9352 if (f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.allocated_p
)
9353 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.pixel
);
9354 if (f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.allocated_p
)
9355 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.pixel
);
9359 /* Free extra GCs allocated by x_setup_relief_colors. */
9360 if (f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
)
9362 XFreeGC (dpyinfo
->display
, f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
);
9363 f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
= 0;
9365 if (f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
)
9367 XFreeGC (dpyinfo
->display
, f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
);
9368 f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
= 0;
9371 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9374 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
);
9375 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
);
9376 f
->output_data
.x
= NULL
;
9378 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
9379 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= 0;
9380 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
)
9381 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
9382 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
9383 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9384 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
9385 reset_mouse_highlight (hlinfo
);
9391 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9394 x_destroy_window (struct frame
*f
)
9396 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9398 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9399 commands to the X server. */
9400 if (dpyinfo
->display
!= 0)
9401 x_free_frame_resources (f
);
9403 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
9407 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9409 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9410 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9411 that the window now has.
9412 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
9413 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9414 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
9418 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame
*f
, long flags
, bool user_position
)
9420 XSizeHints size_hints
;
9421 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9423 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9424 if (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
)
9426 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9431 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9432 size_hints
.flags
= PResizeInc
| PMinSize
/* | PMaxSize */;
9434 size_hints
.x
= f
->left_pos
;
9435 size_hints
.y
= f
->top_pos
;
9437 size_hints
.height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
9438 size_hints
.width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
9440 size_hints
.width_inc
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
9441 size_hints
.height_inc
= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
9442 size_hints
.max_width
= x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
9443 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
9444 size_hints
.max_height
= x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
9445 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
9447 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9449 int base_width
, base_height
;
9450 int min_rows
= 0, min_cols
= 0;
9452 base_width
= FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
9453 base_height
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
9455 check_frame_size (f
, &min_rows
, &min_cols
);
9457 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9458 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9459 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9460 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9461 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9463 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9464 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9465 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9467 size_hints
.flags
|= PBaseSize
;
9468 size_hints
.base_width
= base_width
;
9469 size_hints
.base_height
= base_height
+ FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
9470 size_hints
.min_width
= base_width
+ min_cols
* size_hints
.width_inc
;
9471 size_hints
.min_height
= base_height
+ min_rows
* size_hints
.height_inc
;
9474 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9477 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
9482 XSizeHints hints
; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9483 long supplied_return
;
9486 value
= XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &hints
,
9490 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
9495 if (hints
.flags
& PSize
)
9496 size_hints
.flags
|= PSize
;
9497 if (hints
.flags
& PPosition
)
9498 size_hints
.flags
|= PPosition
;
9499 if (hints
.flags
& USPosition
)
9500 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
9501 if (hints
.flags
& USSize
)
9502 size_hints
.flags
|= USSize
;
9509 size_hints
.win_gravity
= f
->win_gravity
;
9510 size_hints
.flags
|= PWinGravity
;
9514 size_hints
.flags
&= ~ PPosition
;
9515 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
9517 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9519 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &size_hints
);
9521 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9523 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9526 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame
*f
, int state
)
9528 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9531 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNinitialState
, state
);
9532 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9533 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9534 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
9536 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= StateHint
;
9537 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.initial_state
= state
;
9539 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9540 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9544 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame
*f
, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id
)
9546 Pixmap icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
;
9548 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9549 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9554 icon_pixmap
= x_bitmap_pixmap (f
, pixmap_id
);
9555 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_pixmap
= icon_pixmap
;
9556 icon_mask
= x_bitmap_mask (f
, pixmap_id
);
9557 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_mask
= icon_mask
;
9561 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9569 xg_set_frame_icon (f
, icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
);
9573 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9577 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconPixmap
, icon_pixmap
);
9578 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9579 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconMask
, icon_mask
);
9580 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9583 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9585 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= (IconPixmapHint
| IconMaskHint
);
9586 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9588 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9592 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame
*f
, int icon_x
, int icon_y
)
9594 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9596 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= IconPositionHint
;
9597 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_x
= icon_x
;
9598 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_y
= icon_y
;
9600 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9604 /***********************************************************************
9606 ***********************************************************************/
9610 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9614 x_check_font (struct frame
*f
, struct font
*font
)
9616 eassert (font
!= NULL
&& ! NILP (font
->props
[FONT_TYPE_INDEX
]));
9617 if (font
->driver
->check
)
9618 eassert (font
->driver
->check (f
, font
) == 0);
9621 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9624 /***********************************************************************
9626 ***********************************************************************/
9628 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9629 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options
[] = {
9630 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
9631 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg
, (XtPointer
) "yes"},
9633 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9634 XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
9635 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
9637 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9638 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9639 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9640 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9641 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9642 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9643 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
}
9646 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9648 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
;
9650 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9652 static int x_initialized
;
9654 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9655 the screen number from the server number. */
9657 same_x_server (const char *name1
, const char *name2
)
9660 const char *system_name
= SSDATA (Vsystem_name
);
9661 ptrdiff_t system_name_length
= SBYTES (Vsystem_name
);
9662 ptrdiff_t length_until_period
= 0;
9664 while (system_name
[length_until_period
] != 0
9665 && system_name
[length_until_period
] != '.')
9666 length_until_period
++;
9668 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9669 if (! strncmp (name1
, "unix:", 5))
9671 if (! strncmp (name2
, "unix:", 5))
9673 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9674 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
9675 && name1
[system_name_length
] == ':')
9676 name1
+= system_name_length
;
9677 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
9678 && name2
[system_name_length
] == ':')
9679 name2
+= system_name_length
;
9680 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9681 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
9682 && name1
[length_until_period
] == ':')
9683 name1
+= length_until_period
;
9684 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
9685 && name2
[length_until_period
] == ':')
9686 name2
+= length_until_period
;
9688 for (; *name1
!= '\0' && *name1
== *name2
; name1
++, name2
++)
9692 if (seen_colon
&& *name1
== '.')
9696 && (*name1
== '.' || *name1
== '\0')
9697 && (*name2
== '.' || *name2
== '\0'));
9700 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9701 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9704 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask
, int *bits
, int *offset
)
9725 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9726 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9729 x_display_ok (const char *display
)
9731 Display
*dpy
= XOpenDisplay (display
);
9732 return dpy
? (XCloseDisplay (dpy
), 1) : 0;
9737 my_log_handler (const gchar
*log_domain
, GLogLevelFlags log_level
,
9738 const gchar
*msg
, gpointer user_data
)
9740 if (!strstr (msg
, "g_set_prgname"))
9741 fprintf (stderr
, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain
, msg
);
9745 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9746 the structure that describes the open display.
9747 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9749 struct x_display_info
*
9750 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name
, char *xrm_option
, char *resource_name
)
9754 struct terminal
*terminal
;
9755 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
9767 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name
)))
9768 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name
));
9774 char *argv
[NUM_ARGV
];
9775 char **argv2
= argv
;
9778 if (x_initialized
++ > 1)
9780 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name
), &dpy
);
9784 static char display_opt
[] = "--display";
9785 static char name_opt
[] = "--name";
9787 for (argc
= 0; argc
< NUM_ARGV
; ++argc
)
9791 argv
[argc
++] = initial_argv
[0];
9793 if (! NILP (display_name
))
9795 argv
[argc
++] = display_opt
;
9796 argv
[argc
++] = SSDATA (display_name
);
9799 argv
[argc
++] = name_opt
;
9800 argv
[argc
++] = resource_name
;
9802 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9804 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9805 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9806 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
9808 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9809 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9810 id
= g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING
| G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9811 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION
, my_log_handler
, NULL
);
9813 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9814 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9815 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL
, event_handler_gdk
, NULL
);
9817 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
9819 gtk_init (&argc
, &argv2
);
9822 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id
);
9826 dpy
= DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9828 #if ! GTK_CHECK_VERSION (2, 90, 0)
9829 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9831 const char *file
= "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9832 Lisp_Object s
, abs_file
;
9834 s
= build_string (file
);
9835 abs_file
= Fexpand_file_name (s
, Qnil
);
9837 if (! NILP (abs_file
) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file
)))
9838 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file
));
9842 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
9843 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
9846 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9847 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9848 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9850 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9851 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9852 So let's not use it until R6. */
9854 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL
, NULL
, NULL
);
9865 argv
[argc
++] = "-xrm";
9866 argv
[argc
++] = xrm_option
;
9868 turn_on_atimers (0);
9869 dpy
= XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con
, SSDATA (display_name
),
9870 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
,
9871 emacs_options
, XtNumber (emacs_options
),
9873 turn_on_atimers (1);
9876 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9881 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9882 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9883 dpy
= XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name
));
9884 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9885 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9887 /* Detect failure. */
9894 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9896 dpyinfo
= xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo
);
9897 terminal
= x_create_terminal (dpyinfo
);
9900 struct x_display_info
*share
;
9903 for (share
= x_display_list
, tail
= x_display_name_list
; share
;
9904 share
= share
->next
, tail
= XCDR (tail
))
9905 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail
))),
9906 SSDATA (display_name
)))
9909 terminal
->kboard
= share
->terminal
->kboard
;
9912 terminal
->kboard
= xmalloc (sizeof *terminal
->kboard
);
9913 init_kboard (terminal
->kboard
);
9914 kset_window_system (terminal
->kboard
, Qx
);
9916 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
9917 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
9918 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
9919 terminal
->kboard
->next_kboard
= all_kboards
;
9920 all_kboards
= terminal
->kboard
;
9922 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
)->function
, Qunbound
))
9924 char *vendor
= ServerVendor (dpy
);
9926 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
9927 list of terminals. */
9928 struct gcpro gcpro1
;
9929 Lisp_Object gcpro_term
;
9930 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term
, terminal
);
9931 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term
);
9933 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
9934 terminal_list
= terminal
->next_terminal
;
9936 kset_system_key_alist
9938 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
,
9939 vendor
? build_string (vendor
) : empty_unibyte_string
));
9941 terminal
->next_terminal
= terminal_list
;
9942 terminal_list
= terminal
;
9946 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
9947 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
9948 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
9949 if (current_kboard
== initial_kboard
)
9950 current_kboard
= terminal
->kboard
;
9952 terminal
->kboard
->reference_count
++;
9955 /* Put this display on the chain. */
9956 dpyinfo
->next
= x_display_list
;
9957 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
;
9959 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
9960 x_display_name_list
= Fcons (Fcons (display_name
, Qnil
),
9961 x_display_name_list
);
9962 dpyinfo
->name_list_element
= XCAR (x_display_name_list
);
9964 dpyinfo
->display
= dpy
;
9966 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
9967 terminal
->name
= xlispstrdup (display_name
);
9970 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display
, x_trace_wire
);
9973 lim
= min (PTRDIFF_MAX
, SIZE_MAX
) - sizeof "@";
9974 if (lim
- SBYTES (Vinvocation_name
) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name
))
9975 memory_full (SIZE_MAX
);
9976 dpyinfo
->x_id_name
= xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name
)
9977 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name
) + 2);
9978 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name
)), "@"),
9979 SSDATA (Vsystem_name
));
9981 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
9982 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
9984 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
9986 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
9987 dpyinfo
->xg_cursor
= xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo
->display
);
9988 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9990 dpyinfo
->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
9991 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo
->display
, XC_sb_v_double_arrow
);
9993 xrdb
= x_load_resources (dpyinfo
->display
, xrm_option
,
9994 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
);
9995 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
9996 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo
->display
, xrdb
);
9998 dpyinfo
->display
->db
= xrdb
;
10000 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10002 dpyinfo
->xrdb
= xrdb
;
10004 dpyinfo
->screen
= ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
,
10005 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo
->display
));
10006 select_visual (dpyinfo
);
10007 dpyinfo
->cmap
= DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10008 dpyinfo
->root_window
= RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10009 dpyinfo
->icon_bitmap_id
= -1;
10010 dpyinfo
->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
10012 reset_mouse_highlight (&dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
);
10014 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10015 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == TrueColor
)
10017 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->red_mask
,
10018 &dpyinfo
->red_bits
, &dpyinfo
->red_offset
);
10019 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->blue_mask
,
10020 &dpyinfo
->blue_bits
, &dpyinfo
->blue_offset
);
10021 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->green_mask
,
10022 &dpyinfo
->green_bits
, &dpyinfo
->green_offset
);
10025 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10026 if (dpyinfo
->visual
== DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
))
10028 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == PseudoColor
)
10031 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
10032 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10033 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10035 if (STRINGP (value
)
10036 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
10037 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
10038 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->cmap
);
10042 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCreateColormap (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
10043 dpyinfo
->visual
, AllocNone
);
10047 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10048 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10049 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10050 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10051 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10053 char *v
= XGetDefault (dpyinfo
->display
, "Xft", "dpi");
10055 if (v
!= NULL
&& sscanf (v
, "%lf", &d
) == 1)
10056 dpyinfo
->resy
= dpyinfo
->resx
= d
;
10060 if (dpyinfo
->resy
< 1)
10062 int screen_number
= XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10063 double pixels
= DisplayHeight (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10064 double mm
= DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10065 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10066 dpyinfo
->resy
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
10067 pixels
= DisplayWidth (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10068 mm
= DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10069 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10070 dpyinfo
->resx
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
10074 static const struct
10079 #define ATOM_REFS_INIT(string, member) \
10080 { string, offsetof (struct x_display_info, member) },
10081 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_PROTOCOLS", Xatom_wm_protocols
)
10082 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_TAKE_FOCUS", Xatom_wm_take_focus
)
10083 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", Xatom_wm_save_yourself
)
10084 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_DELETE_WINDOW", Xatom_wm_delete_window
)
10085 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CHANGE_STATE", Xatom_wm_change_state
)
10086 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", Xatom_wm_configure_denied
)
10087 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_MOVED", Xatom_wm_window_moved
)
10088 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CLIENT_LEADER", Xatom_wm_client_leader
)
10089 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("Editres", Xatom_editres
)
10090 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD", Xatom_CLIPBOARD
)
10091 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TIMESTAMP", Xatom_TIMESTAMP
)
10092 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TEXT", Xatom_TEXT
)
10093 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("COMPOUND_TEXT", Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
)
10094 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("UTF8_STRING", Xatom_UTF8_STRING
)
10095 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DELETE", Xatom_DELETE
)
10096 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MULTIPLE", Xatom_MULTIPLE
)
10097 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("INCR", Xatom_INCR
)
10098 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_EMACS_TMP_", Xatom_EMACS_TMP
)
10099 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TARGETS", Xatom_TARGETS
)
10100 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("NULL", Xatom_NULL
)
10101 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM", Xatom_ATOM
)
10102 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM_PAIR", Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
)
10103 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER
)
10104 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED_INFO", Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
)
10105 /* For properties of font. */
10106 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PIXEL_SIZE", Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
)
10107 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("AVERAGE_WIDTH", Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
)
10108 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
)
10109 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
)
10110 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
)
10111 /* Ghostscript support. */
10112 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DONE", Xatom_DONE
)
10113 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PAGE", Xatom_PAGE
)
10114 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Scrollbar
)
10115 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED", Xatom_XEMBED
)
10117 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE", Xatom_net_wm_state
)
10118 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
)
10119 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10120 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
)
10121 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10122 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
)
10123 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
)
10124 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden
)
10125 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", Xatom_net_window_type
)
10126 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10127 Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip
)
10128 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_icon_name
)
10129 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_name
)
10130 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTED", Xatom_net_supported
)
10131 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check
)
10132 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
)
10133 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", Xatom_net_active_window
)
10134 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", Xatom_net_frame_extents
)
10135 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_CURRENT_DESKTOP", Xatom_net_current_desktop
)
10136 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WORKAREA", Xatom_net_workarea
)
10137 /* Session management */
10138 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SM_CLIENT_ID", Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID
)
10139 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", Xatom_xsettings_prop
)
10140 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MANAGER", Xatom_xsettings_mgr
)
10144 const int atom_count
= sizeof (atom_refs
) / sizeof (atom_refs
[0]);
10145 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10146 const int total_atom_count
= 1 + atom_count
;
10147 Atom
*atoms_return
= xmalloc (total_atom_count
* sizeof *atoms_return
);
10148 char **atom_names
= xmalloc (total_atom_count
* sizeof *atom_names
);
10149 static char const xsettings_fmt
[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10150 char xsettings_atom_name
[sizeof xsettings_fmt
- 2
10151 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10153 for (i
= 0; i
< atom_count
; i
++)
10154 atom_names
[i
] = (char *) atom_refs
[i
].name
;
10156 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10157 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name
, xsettings_fmt
,
10158 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
));
10159 atom_names
[i
] = xsettings_atom_name
;
10161 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo
->display
, atom_names
, total_atom_count
,
10162 False
, atoms_return
);
10164 for (i
= 0; i
< atom_count
; i
++)
10165 *(Atom
*) ((char *) dpyinfo
+ atom_refs
[i
].offset
) = atoms_return
[i
];
10167 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10168 dpyinfo
->Xatom_xsettings_sel
= atoms_return
[i
];
10170 xfree (atom_names
);
10171 xfree (atoms_return
);
10174 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
= 8;
10175 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
= xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
10176 * dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
);
10178 connection
= ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo
->display
);
10179 dpyinfo
->connection
= connection
;
10181 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
10182 gray_bits
, gray_width
, gray_height
,
10186 xim_initialize (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
10189 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo
);
10191 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10192 if (connection
!= 0)
10193 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection
);
10196 fcntl (connection
, F_SETOWN
, getpid ());
10197 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10199 if (interrupt_input
)
10200 init_sigio (connection
);
10204 XrmValue d
, fr
, to
;
10207 dpy
= dpyinfo
->display
;
10208 d
.addr
= (XPointer
)&dpy
;
10209 d
.size
= sizeof (Display
*);
10210 fr
.addr
= XtDefaultFont
;
10211 fr
.size
= sizeof (XtDefaultFont
);
10212 to
.size
= sizeof (Font
*);
10213 to
.addr
= (XPointer
)&font
;
10214 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
10215 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy
, XtCvtStringToFont
, &d
, 1, &fr
, &to
, NULL
))
10217 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
) || !XQueryFont (dpy
, font
))
10218 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb
, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10219 x_uncatch_errors ();
10223 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10224 for debugging X code. */
10227 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
10228 build_string ("synchronous"),
10229 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10231 if (STRINGP (value
)
10232 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
10233 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
10234 XSynchronize (dpyinfo
->display
, True
);
10239 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
10240 build_string ("useXIM"),
10241 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10244 if (STRINGP (value
)
10245 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "false")
10246 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "off")))
10249 if (STRINGP (value
)
10250 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
10251 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
10257 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10258 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10260 if (terminal
->id
== 1)
10261 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo
);
10269 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10270 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10273 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
10275 struct terminal
*t
;
10277 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10279 for (t
= terminal_list
; t
; t
= t
->next_terminal
)
10280 if (t
->type
== output_x_window
&& t
->display_info
.x
== dpyinfo
)
10283 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10284 if (t
->id
== 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10285 x_session_close ();
10287 delete_terminal (t
);
10291 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo
->connection
);
10293 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10294 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10295 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list
)
10296 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list
), dpyinfo
->name_list_element
))
10297 x_display_name_list
= XCDR (x_display_name_list
);
10302 tail
= x_display_name_list
;
10303 while (CONSP (tail
) && CONSP (XCDR (tail
)))
10305 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail
)), dpyinfo
->name_list_element
))
10307 XSETCDR (tail
, XCDR (XCDR (tail
)));
10310 tail
= XCDR (tail
);
10314 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== dpyinfo
)
10315 next_noop_dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
;
10317 if (x_display_list
== dpyinfo
)
10318 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
->next
;
10321 struct x_display_info
*tail
;
10323 for (tail
= x_display_list
; tail
; tail
= tail
->next
)
10324 if (tail
->next
== dpyinfo
)
10325 tail
->next
= tail
->next
->next
;
10328 xfree (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
);
10329 xfree (dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
);
10330 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
10334 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10336 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10337 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10338 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10339 that slows us down. */
10342 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer
*timer
)
10345 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= 0;
10346 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
|| popup_activated ())
10348 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con
) & XtIMTimer
)
10349 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con
, XtIMTimer
);
10350 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10351 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10356 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10357 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10358 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10359 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10360 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10361 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10362 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10365 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10368 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
)
10370 struct timespec interval
= make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10371 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE
, interval
, x_process_timeouts
, 0);
10372 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= 1;
10377 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10380 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10382 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface
=
10384 x_frame_parm_handlers
,
10388 x_clear_end_of_line
,
10390 x_after_update_window_line
,
10391 x_update_window_begin
,
10392 x_update_window_end
,
10397 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10399 x_clear_window_mouse_face
,
10400 x_get_glyph_overhangs
,
10401 x_fix_overlapping_area
,
10402 x_draw_fringe_bitmap
,
10403 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10404 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10405 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs
,
10406 x_draw_glyph_string
,
10407 x_define_frame_cursor
,
10408 x_clear_frame_area
,
10409 x_draw_window_cursor
,
10410 x_draw_vertical_window_border
,
10411 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10415 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10417 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal
*terminal
)
10419 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= terminal
->display_info
.x
;
10421 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10422 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10423 if (!terminal
->name
)
10428 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10431 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo
);
10434 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10435 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10436 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
10438 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo
);
10439 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo
->display
, DestroyAll
);
10441 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10442 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10443 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10444 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10446 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10447 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10448 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10449 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10450 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10451 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10452 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10453 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10454 leaks in other situations. */
10456 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10457 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo
->display
, NULL
);
10459 dpyinfo
->display
->db
= NULL
;
10461 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10462 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10463 closing all the displays. */
10464 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo
->xrdb
);
10468 xg_display_close (dpyinfo
->display
);
10470 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10471 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
10473 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
10475 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10478 /* Mark as dead. */
10479 dpyinfo
->display
= NULL
;
10480 x_delete_display (dpyinfo
);
10484 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10485 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10487 static struct terminal
*
10488 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
10490 struct terminal
*terminal
;
10492 terminal
= create_terminal ();
10494 terminal
->type
= output_x_window
;
10495 terminal
->display_info
.x
= dpyinfo
;
10496 dpyinfo
->terminal
= terminal
;
10498 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10500 terminal
->clear_frame_hook
= x_clear_frame
;
10501 terminal
->ins_del_lines_hook
= x_ins_del_lines
;
10502 terminal
->delete_glyphs_hook
= x_delete_glyphs
;
10503 terminal
->ring_bell_hook
= XTring_bell
;
10504 terminal
->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook
= XTtoggle_invisible_pointer
;
10505 terminal
->reset_terminal_modes_hook
= NULL
;
10506 terminal
->set_terminal_modes_hook
= NULL
;
10507 terminal
->update_begin_hook
= x_update_begin
;
10508 terminal
->update_end_hook
= x_update_end
;
10509 terminal
->set_terminal_window_hook
= NULL
;
10510 terminal
->read_socket_hook
= XTread_socket
;
10511 terminal
->frame_up_to_date_hook
= XTframe_up_to_date
;
10512 terminal
->mouse_position_hook
= XTmouse_position
;
10513 terminal
->frame_rehighlight_hook
= XTframe_rehighlight
;
10514 terminal
->frame_raise_lower_hook
= XTframe_raise_lower
;
10515 terminal
->fullscreen_hook
= XTfullscreen_hook
;
10516 terminal
->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook
= XTset_vertical_scroll_bar
;
10517 terminal
->condemn_scroll_bars_hook
= XTcondemn_scroll_bars
;
10518 terminal
->redeem_scroll_bar_hook
= XTredeem_scroll_bar
;
10519 terminal
->judge_scroll_bars_hook
= XTjudge_scroll_bars
;
10521 terminal
->delete_frame_hook
= x_destroy_window
;
10522 terminal
->delete_terminal_hook
= x_delete_terminal
;
10524 terminal
->rif
= &x_redisplay_interface
;
10525 terminal
->scroll_region_ok
= 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10526 terminal
->char_ins_del_ok
= 1;
10527 terminal
->line_ins_del_ok
= 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10528 terminal
->fast_clear_end_of_line
= 1; /* X does this well. */
10529 terminal
->memory_below_frame
= 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10536 x_initialize (void)
10541 last_tool_bar_item
= -1;
10542 any_help_event_p
= 0;
10543 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
10546 current_count
= -1;
10549 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10550 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt
);
10552 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10553 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10555 Xt_app_con
= XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10557 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10558 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10559 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con
,
10560 XtRString
, XtRPixel
, cvt_string_to_pixel
,
10561 cvt_string_to_pixel_args
,
10562 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args
),
10563 XtCacheByDisplay
, cvt_pixel_dtor
);
10565 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con
, Xt_default_resources
);
10568 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10570 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= False
;
10571 xaw3d_pick_top
= True
;
10575 pending_autoraise_frame
= 0;
10576 pending_event_wait
.f
= 0;
10577 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= 0;
10579 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10580 original error handler. */
10581 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
10582 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
10587 syms_of_xterm (void)
10589 x_error_message
= NULL
;
10591 staticpro (&x_display_name_list
);
10592 x_display_name_list
= Qnil
;
10594 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar
);
10595 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
10597 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10598 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1
, "latin-1");
10601 xg_default_icon_file
= build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10602 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file
);
10604 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock
, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10607 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10608 x_use_underline_position_properties
,
10609 doc
: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10610 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10611 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10612 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10613 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10615 x_use_underline_position_properties
= 1;
10617 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10618 x_underline_at_descent_line
,
10619 doc
: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10620 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10621 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10622 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10623 x_underline_at_descent_line
= 0;
10625 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10626 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
,
10627 doc
: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10628 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10629 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10630 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10631 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10632 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10633 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
= 0;
10635 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
,
10636 doc
: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10637 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10638 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10639 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10640 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10641 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10643 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("motif");
10644 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10645 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10647 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("gtk");
10649 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("xaw");
10652 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= Qnil
;
10655 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame
);
10656 last_mouse_motion_frame
= Qnil
;
10658 Qmodifier_value
= intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10659 Qalt
= intern_c_string ("alt");
10660 Fput (Qalt
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (alt_modifier
));
10661 Qhyper
= intern_c_string ("hyper");
10662 Fput (Qhyper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (hyper_modifier
));
10663 Qmeta
= intern_c_string ("meta");
10664 Fput (Qmeta
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (meta_modifier
));
10665 Qsuper
= intern_c_string ("super");
10666 Fput (Qsuper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (super_modifier
));
10668 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym
,
10669 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10670 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10671 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10672 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10673 Vx_alt_keysym
= Qnil
;
10675 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym
,
10676 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10677 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10678 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10679 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10680 Vx_hyper_keysym
= Qnil
;
10682 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym
,
10683 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10684 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10685 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10686 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10687 Vx_meta_keysym
= Qnil
;
10689 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym
,
10690 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10691 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10692 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10693 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10694 Vx_super_keysym
= Qnil
;
10696 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table
,
10697 doc
: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10698 Vx_keysym_table
= make_hash_table (hashtest_eql
, make_number (900),
10699 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE
),
10700 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD
),
10704 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */